Canon All in One Printer NP7161 User Manual

SERVICE  
MANUAL  
REVISION 0  
FY8-13FB-000  
AUG. 1998  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION  
This Service Manual contains basic facts and figures on the NP7161/NP7160  
needed to service the machine in the field.  
This copier is designed to enable full automatic copying work, and comes with the  
following systems accessories:  
1. ADF-G1*  
2. Staper Sorter-L1*  
3. MS-C1*  
4. Cassette Feeding Module-C1  
* NP7161 only.  
This Service Manual covers the copier only, and consists of the following chapters:  
Chapter 1 General Description introduces the copier’s features and specifications,  
shows how to operate the copier, and explains how copies are made.  
Chapter 2 Basic Operation provides outlines of the copier's various mechanical  
workings.  
Chapter 3 Exposure System discusses the principles of operation used for the  
copier's lens drive unit and scanner drive unit. It also explains the timing at  
which these drive units are operated, and shows how they may be  
disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
Chapter 4 Image Formation System discusses the principles of how images are  
formed. It also explains the timing at which the various units involved in  
image formation are operated, and shows how they may be disassembled/  
assembled and adjusted.  
Chapter 5 Pick-Up/Feeding System explains the principles used from when copy  
paper is picked up to when a copy is delivered in view of the functions of  
electrical and mechanical units and in relation to their timing of operation. It  
also shows how these units may be disassembled/assembled and  
adjusted.  
Chapter 6 Fixing System explains the principles used to fuse toner images to transfer  
media in view of the functions of electrical and mechanical units and in  
relation to their timing of operation. It also shows how these units may be  
disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
Chapter 7 Externals/Auxiliary Mechanisms shows the copier’s external parts, and  
explains the principles used for the copier’s various control mechanisms in  
view of the functions of electrical and mechanical units and in relation to  
their timing of operation. It also shows how these units may be  
disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
Chapter 8 Installation introduces requirements for the site of installation, and shows  
how the copier may be installed using step-by-step instructions.  
Chapter 9 Maintenance and Servicing provides tables of periodically replaced parts  
and consumables/durables and scheduled servicing charts.  
Chapter 10 Troubleshooting provides tables of maintenance/inspection, standards/  
adjustments, and problem identification (image fault/malfunction).  
Appendix contains a general timing chart and general circuit diagrams.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following rules apply throughout this Service Manual:  
1. Each chapter contains sections explaining the purpose of specific functions  
and the relationship between electrical and mechanical systems with reference  
to the timing of operation.  
In the diagrams,  
signal name accompanies the symbol  
direction of the electric signal.  
represents the path of mechanical drive—where a  
, the arrow indicates the  
The expression “turn on the power” means flipping on the power switch,  
closing the front door, and closing the delivery unit door, which results in  
supplying the machine with power.  
2. In the digital circuits, ‘1’ is used to indicate that the voltage level of a given  
signal is “High,” while ‘0’ is used to indicate “Low.” (The voltage value,  
however, differs from circuit to circuit.)  
In practically all cases, the internal mechanisms of a microprocessor cannot be  
checked in the field. Therefore, the operations of the microprocessors used in  
the machines are not discussed: they are explained in terms of from sensors to  
the input of the DC controller PCB and from the output of the DC controller  
PCB to the loads.  
The descriptions in this Service Manual are subject to change without notice for  
product improvement or other purposes, and major changes will be communicated in  
the form of Service Information bulletins.  
All service persons are expected to have a good understanding of the contents of this  
Service Manual and all relevant Service Information bulletins and be able to identify and  
isolate faults in the machine.  
ii  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Configuration  
The copier is designed to accommodate the following accessories:  
*NP7161 only.  
ADF-G1*  
Feeds a stack of original  
pages to the copyboard  
page by page.  
Control  
Card IV N  
Controls volumes  
of copying work.  
MS-C1*  
Stapler Sorter-L1*  
Sorts and groups up to In addition to the functions  
10 sets of pages  
automatically.  
of a 10-bin sorter, staples  
sorted pages automatically.  
Cassette Feeding Module-C1  
Provides an additional cassette.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iv  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
I. FEATURES .............................................. 1-1  
IV. OPERATING THE MACHINE ................ 1-10  
A. Control Panel.................................... 1-10  
B. User Mode ........................................ 1-12  
1. Outline ........................................ 1-12  
V. ROUTINE MAINTENANCE  
(BY THE USER) .................................... 1-14  
VI. PONITS TO NOTE (BY THE USER) ..... 1-15  
VII. IMAGE FORMATION ............................. 1-16  
A. Outline .............................................. 1-16  
II. SPECIFICATIONS ................................... 1-2  
A. Copier ................................................. 1-2  
1. Type ............................................. 1-2  
2. Mechanisms ................................. 1-2  
3. Performance................................. 1-3  
4. Others........................................... 1-5  
III. NAMES OF PARTS.................................. 1-8  
A. External View ..................................... 1-8  
B. Cross Section ..................................... 1-9  
1. Copier ........................................... 1-9  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
I. BASIC MECHANISMS ............................. 2-1  
A. Functional Construction ..................... 2-1  
B. Outline of the Electrical Circuitry........ 2-2  
C. Basic Sequence of Operations .......... 2-4  
1. Basic Sequence of Operations at  
Power-On ..................................... 2-4  
2. Basic Sequence of Operations at  
Copy Start .................................... 2-6  
D. Main Motor (M1) Control Circuitry...... 2-8  
1. Outline .......................................... 2-8  
2. Operation...................................... 2-8  
3. Detecting an Error ........................ 2-8  
E. Inputs to the DC Controller ................ 2-9  
1. Inputs to the  
2. Inputs to the  
DC Controller (2/3) ..................... 2-10  
3. Inputs to the  
DC Controller (3/3) ..................... 2-11  
F. Outputs from the DC Controller ....... 2-12  
1. Outputs from the  
DC Controller (1/4) ..................... 2-12  
2. Outputs from the  
DC Controller (2/4) ..................... 2-13  
3. Outputs from the  
DC Controller (3/4) ..................... 2-14  
4. Outputs from the  
DC Controller (4/4) ..................... 2-15  
G. Inputs to and Outputs from  
Accessories (1/1) ............................. 2-16  
DC Controller (1/3) ....................... 2-9  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION ..................... 3-1  
1. Outline ........................................ 3-10  
2. Detection of the Original Size  
A. Changing the Reproduction Ratio...... 3-1  
II. LENS DRIVE SYSTEM ............................ 3-3  
A. Driving the Lens ................................. 3-3  
1. Outline .......................................... 3-3  
2. Motor Control Circuit .................... 3-4  
3. Moving the Lens........................... 3-5  
III. SCANNER DRIVE SYSTEM.................... 3-6  
A. Outline ................................................ 3-6  
B. Scanner Motor Control Circuit ........... 3-7  
C. Relationship between Scanner  
by the ADF ................................. 3-10  
V. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................. 3-11  
A. Scanner Drive Assembly.................. 3-12  
1. Removing the Scanner Motor .... 3-12  
2. Removing the Scanner Drive  
Cable .......................................... 3-13  
3. Routing the Scanner Drive  
Cable .......................................... 3-15  
4. Adjusting the Position  
Sensor and Signals ............................ 3-7  
D. Basic Sequence of Operations  
of the Mirror ................................ 3-16  
5. Adjusting the Tension  
(scanner) ........................................... 3-8  
E. Scanner Movement in  
Page Separation Mode ...................... 3-9  
IV. OTHERS................................................. 3-10  
A. Detecting the Original Size .............. 3-10  
of the Scanner Drive Cable........ 3-17  
B. Lens Drive Assembly ....................... 3-18  
1. Removing the Lens Drive  
Motor .......................................... 3-18  
2. Removing the Mirror Motor ........ 3-19  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF THE PROCESSES............ 4-1  
4. Turning On the Blank Exposure  
Lamp in Multifeeder Mode ......... 4-13  
II. DEVELOPING ASSEMBLY/DRUM  
CLEANER ASSEMBLY .......................... 4-14  
A. Outline .............................................. 4-14  
B. Detecting and Controlling  
A. Outline ................................................ 4-1  
B. Basic Sequence of Operations  
(image formation system) .................. 4-2  
C. Controlling the Intensity of the  
Scanning Lamp .................................. 4-3  
1. Outline .......................................... 4-3  
2. Operation...................................... 4-4  
3. Protection Mechanisms ............... 4-5  
D. Controlling the Primary/Transfer Bias .. 4-6  
1. Outline .......................................... 4-6  
2. Turning On/Off the Primary/  
the Level of Toner ............................ 4-16  
C. Monitoring the Waste Toner  
Feeding Screw ................................. 4-17  
D. Monitoring the Waste Toner Box ..... 4-18  
E. Control by the Cleaner Thermistor... 4-20  
1. Copying Speed Down  
Transfer Bias ................................ 4-6  
E. Controlling the Developing/Separation  
Static Eliminator Bias ......................... 4-7  
1. Outline .......................................... 4-7  
2. Turning On/Off the Developing  
Sequence ................................... 4-20  
F. Auto Density Adjustment (AE) ......... 4-21  
1. Outline ........................................ 4-21  
2. Measuring the Density  
of the Original ............................. 4-21  
III. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................. 4-23  
A. Scanning Lamp Assembly ............... 4-24  
1. Removing the Scanning Lamp .. 4-24  
2. Mounting the Scanning Lamp .... 4-25  
3. Removing the Thermal Fuse ..... 4-25  
B. Exposure Assembly ......................... 4-26  
1. Removing the Pre-Exposure/  
DC Bias ........................................ 4-8  
3. Turning On/Off the Developing  
AC Bias/Separation Eliminator  
Bias .............................................. 4-9  
4. Controlling the Developing  
DC Bias to a Specific Voltage  
to Suit Copy Density .................. 4-10  
F. Controlling the Blank Exposure Lamp ... 4-12  
1. Outline ........................................ 4-12  
2. Turning On the Blank Exposure  
Lamp in Reduce Mode............... 4-13  
3. Turning On the Blank Exposure  
Lamp in Direct/Enlarge Mode .... 4-13  
Blank Exposure Lamp  
Assembly.................................... 4-26  
2. Removing the Dust-Proofing  
Glass .......................................... 4-26  
3. Cleaning the No. 6 Mirror........... 4-27  
C. Drum Unit ......................................... 4-28  
vi  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. Outline ........................................ 4-32  
2. Stringing the Charging Wires..... 4-32  
3. Adjusting the Height of the  
1. Removing the Drum Unit ........... 4-28  
2. Cleaning the Photosensitive  
Drum........................................... 4-29  
3. Removing the Cleaner  
Charging Wires .......................... 4-36  
G. Developing Assembly....................... 4-37  
1. Removing the Developing  
Thermistor .................................. 4-29  
D. Primary Charging Assembly ............ 4-30  
1. Removing the Primary  
Charging Assembly .................... 4-30  
E. Transfer Charging Assembly ........... 4-31  
1. Removing the Transfer  
Assembly.................................... 4-37  
2. Removing the Developing  
Blade .......................................... 4-37  
3. Removing the Developing  
Cylinder ...................................... 4-38  
Charging Assembly .................... 4-31  
F. Charging Wire .................................. 4-32  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION ..................... 5-1  
2. Mounting the Pick-Up Roller ...... 5-16  
II. PICK-UP FROM THE CASSETTE .......... 5-2  
A. Pick-Up Operation .............................. 5-2  
B. Sequence of Operations  
3. Removing the Pick-Up Drive  
Assembly.................................... 5-17  
4. Removing the Pick-Up  
(pick-up/feeding) ................................ 5-3  
C. Operation of the Cassette Lifter ......... 5-4  
D. Detecting the Size of the Cassette .... 5-6  
1. Outline .......................................... 5-6  
2. Detecting the Cassette Size ........ 5-7  
III. PICK-UP FROM THE MULTIFEEDER .... 5-8  
A. Pick-Up Operation .............................. 5-8  
B. Detecting the Size of Paper  
Assembly.................................... 5-17  
5. Removing the Feed Roller ......... 5-18  
6. Removing the Separation Roller .. 5-18  
7. Mounting the Separation Roller ... 5-19  
B. Multifeeder Assembly....................... 5-20  
1. Removing the Multifeeder Tray.... 5-20  
2. Removing the Multifeeder  
Assembly .................................... 5-20  
3. Removing the Multifeeder  
Pick-Up Roller ............................ 5-21  
4. Removing the Separation Pad..... 5-21  
5. Adjusting the Pressure of the  
in the Multifeeder................................ 5-9  
C. Sequence of Operations  
(pick-up from multifeeder) ................ 5-10  
IV. CONTROLLING THE REGISTRATION  
CLUTCH ................................................. 5-11  
V. DETECTING JAMS ................................ 5-12  
A. Outline .............................................. 5-12  
B. Sequence of Operations  
(jam detection).................................. 5-13  
1. Registration Delay Jam.............. 5-13  
2. Registration Stationary Jam....... 5-13  
3. Delivery Delay Jam .................... 5-14  
4. Delivery Stationary Jam ............. 5-14  
VI. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................. 5-15  
A. Pick-Up Assembly ............................ 5-16  
1. Removing the Pick-Up Roller..... 5-16  
Separation Pad .......................... 5-22  
C. Registration Roller Assembly........... 5-23  
1. Removing the Registration  
Roller Assembly ......................... 5-23  
D. Cassette Assembly .......................... 5-24  
1. Removing the Cassette Size  
Switch ......................................... 5-24  
2. Changing the Cassette Size  
(AB/INCH) .................................. 5-25  
3. Adjusting the Left/Right  
Registration ................................ 5-26  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION ..................... 6-1  
6. Removing the Main Thermistor ... 6-12  
7. Removing the Sub Thermistor ... 6-12  
8. Removing the Fixing Upper  
Roller .......................................... 6-13  
9. Removing the Fixing Lower  
Roller .......................................... 6-14  
10. Removing the Heat Discharge  
Roller .......................................... 6-14  
11. Adjusting the Height of the  
A. Outline ................................................ 6-1  
B. Controlling the Fixing Temperature ... 6-2  
C. Error Detection Circuit........................ 6-5  
1. Outline .......................................... 6-5  
2. Surface Temperature of the  
Fixing Upper Roller ...................... 6-6  
3. Activation of the  
Fixing Heater (H1)........................ 6-6  
II. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................... 6-7  
A. Fixing Assembly ................................. 6-8  
1. Construction ................................. 6-8  
2. Locking Mechanism ..................... 6-8  
3. Removing the Fixing Assembly ... 6-8  
4. Removing the Fixing Heater ...... 6-10  
5. Removing the Thermal Switch  
Fixing Inlet Guide ....................... 6-14  
12. Adjusting the Nip ........................ 6-15  
B. Delivery Assembly............................ 6-16  
1. Removing the Upper  
Separation Claw......................... 6-16  
2. Removing the Lower  
Separation Claw......................... 6-16  
3. Removing the Delivery Roller .... 6-17  
Assembly.................................... 6-11  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
I. FANS ........................................................ 7-1  
II. POWER SUPPLY..................................... 7-4  
A. Outline of Power Supply .................... 7-4  
B. Power Supply Circuitry....................... 7-5  
1. AC Power Supply ......................... 7-5  
2. DC Power Supply......................... 7-5  
3. Mirror Heater, Cassette/  
1. Removing the Copyboard  
Glass .......................................... 7-14  
D. Fans.................................................. 7-15  
1. Removing the Scanner  
Cooling Fan ................................ 7-15  
2. Removing the Exhaust Fan ....... 7-16  
3. Remove the Ozone Filter ........... 7-17  
E. Counter Assembly ............................ 7-18  
1. Removing the Counter  
Assembly.................................... 7-18  
F. Main Motor Assembly....................... 7-18  
1. Removing the Main Motor  
Assembly.................................... 7-18  
G. DC Controller PCB ........................... 7-19  
1. Removing the  
Drum Heater, and Accessory  
Cassette Heater ........................... 7-6  
4. ADF and Sorter ............................ 7-6  
C. Protection Mechanisms of the  
Power Supply Circuitry....................... 7-7  
III. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................... 7-8  
A. External Covers.................................. 7-9  
1. Removing the Right Door .......... 7-10  
2. Removing the Upper  
DC Controller PCB ..................... 7-19  
2. Points to Note When Replacing  
the DC Controller PCB............... 7-19  
H. Removing the Power Supply PCB ... 7-20  
1. Removing the  
Right Cover ................................ 7-10  
3. Removing the Upper  
Left Cover................................... 7-11  
4. Removing the Delivery  
Lower Cover ............................... 7-11  
5. Removing the Delivery  
Power Supply PCB .................... 7-20  
I. Removing the High-Voltage  
Upper Cover ............................... 7-11  
6. Removing the Lower  
Power Supply PCB........................... 7-20  
1. Removing the High-Voltage  
Inside Cover ............................... 7-12  
B. Control Panel.................................... 7-13  
1. Removing the Control Panel ...... 7-13  
C. Copyboard Glass ............................. 7-14  
Power Supply PCB .................... 7-20  
J. Lamp Regulator PCB ....................... 7-21  
1. Removing the Lamp  
Regulator PCB ........................... 7-21  
viii  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
I. SELECTING THE SITE............................ 8-1  
IV. INSTALLING THE CONTROL  
II. UNPACKING AND INSTALLATION ........ 8-2  
A. Unpacking .......................................... 8-2  
B. Removing the Metal Fixings............... 8-3  
C. Mounting the Drum Unit ..................... 8-4  
D. Cleaning the Parts and Making Checks .. 8-6  
E. Checking the Images/Operations and  
User Mode .......................................... 8-8  
F. Supplying Toner ............................... 8-10  
III. RELOCATING THE MACHINE .............. 8-12  
CARD IV N ............................................. 8-13  
V. INSTALLING THE REMOTE  
DIAGNOSTIC DEVICE II .......................... 8-14  
VI. INSTALLING THE ACCESSORY  
COUNTER ................................................8-23  
VII. INSTALLING THE ACCESSORY  
HEATER ................................................. 8-25  
A. Installing the Heater Switch ............. 8-25  
B. Mounting the Cassette/Drum Heater 8-26  
C. Installing the Mirror Heater............... 8-27  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
I. PERIODICALLY REPLACED PARTS ..... 9-1  
A. Copier ................................................. 9-1  
II. CONSUMABLES AND DURABLES ........ 9-2  
A. Copier ................................................. 9-2  
III. SCHEDULED SERVICING CHART ........ 9-3  
IV. SCHEDULED SERVICING TABLE ......... 9-5  
A. Copier ................................................. 9-5  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
I. GUIDE TO TROUBLESHOOTING  
TABLES .................................................. 10-1  
A. Image Adjustment Basic Procedure 10-3  
B. Points to Note for Scheduled Servicing . 10-4  
II. STANDARDS AND ADJUSTMENTS .... 10-5  
A. Mechanical ....................................... 10-5  
1. Leading Edge Non-Image  
2. Changing the Cassette Size  
(AB/INCH) ................................ 10-14  
E. Fixing System ................................. 10-16  
1. Adjusting the Height of the  
Fixing Assembly Inlet Guide .... 10-16  
2. Adjusting the Pressure of  
the Lower Roller (nip)............... 10-16  
F. Electrical System............................ 10-18  
1. Obtaining Optimum Exposure ... 10-18  
2. AE Adjustment ......................... 10-19  
3. After Replacing the  
Width (blank exposure lamp  
off timing).................................... 10-5  
2. Image Leading Edge Margin  
(registration on timing) ............... 10-5  
3. Left/Right Registration  
DC Controller PCB ................... 10-22  
4. Checking the Photointerrupters .... 10-23  
III. IMAGE FAULTS ................................... 10-25  
A. Initial Checks .................................. 10-25  
1. Checking the Site Environment .... 10-25  
2. Checking the Originals............. 10-25  
3. Checking the Copyboard  
(cassette).................................... 10-6  
B. Exposure System ............................. 10-7  
1. Routing the Scanner Drive  
Cable .......................................... 10-7  
2. Adjusting the Position  
of the Mirror ................................ 10-8  
3. Adjusting the Tension  
Cover and Copyboard Glass ... 10-25  
4. Checking the Charging  
Assembly.................................. 10-26  
5. Checking the Developing  
Assembly.................................. 10-26  
6. Checking the Paper ................. 10-26  
7. Checking the Periodically  
Replaced Parts......................... 10-26  
8. Others....................................... 10-26  
of the Scanner Drive Cable........ 10-9  
C. Image Formation System ............... 10-10  
1. Outline ...................................... 10-10  
2. Stringing the Charging Wires ... 10-10  
3. Adjusting the Height of the  
Charging Wires ........................ 10-13  
D. Pick-Up/Feeding System ............... 10-14  
1. Adjusting the Pressure  
of the Separation Pad .............. 10-14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B. Image Fault Samples ..................... 10-28  
C. Troubleshooting Image Faults ....... 10-29  
1. The copy is too light.  
17. E800 ......................................... 10-51  
18. E805 ......................................... 10-51  
19. E821 ......................................... 10-51  
20. AC power is absent. ................. 10-52  
21. DC power supply is absent. ..... 10-53  
22. The scanner fails to move........ 10-54  
23. The lens fails to move. ............. 10-55  
24. The mirror fails to move. .......... 10-55  
25. The scanning lamp  
fails to turn on........................... 10-56  
26. The pre-exposure lamp  
fails to turn on........................... 10-57  
27. The blank exposure lamp  
fails to turn on........................... 10-57  
28. Pick-up fails. (cassette)............ 10-58  
29. Pick-up operation fails.  
(multifeeder) ............................. 10-59  
30. The registration roller fails  
to rotate. ................................... 10-59  
31. The fixing heater fails to  
turn on. ..................................... 10-60  
32. The Add Toner indicator  
does not flash/turn on. ............. 10-60  
33. The Add Toner indicator fails  
to turn off. ................................. 10-61  
34. The Waste Toner Box Full i  
ndicator fails to flash/turn on. ... 10-61  
35. The Waste Toner Box Full  
indicator fails to turn off............ 10-62  
36. The Add Paper indicator  
fails to flash. ............................. 10-62  
37. The Add Paper indicator  
fails to turn off........................... 10-63  
38. The Jam indicator fails to  
(halftone area only) .................. 10-29  
2. The copy is too light.  
(including solid black area) ...... 10-30  
3. The copy is too light.  
(entirely, considerably)............. 10-30  
4. The copy has uneven density.  
(front side dark) ........................ 10-31  
5. The copy has uneven density.  
(front side light) ........................ 10-31  
6. The copy is foggy. (overall)...... 10-32  
7. The copy is foggy. (vertical) ..... 10-33  
8. The copy has black lines.  
(vertical, fuzzy, thick) ............... 10-33  
9. The copy has black lines.  
(vertical, thin)............................ 10-33  
10. The copy has white spots.  
(vertical).................................... 10-34  
11. The copy has white lines.  
(vertical).................................... 10-34  
12. The copy has white spots.  
(vertical).................................... 10-35  
13. The back of the copy is soiled. .. 10-36  
14. The copy has faulty fixing. ....... 10-37  
15. The copy has a displaced  
leading edge............................. 10-38  
16. The copy has a displaced  
leading edge............................. 10-38  
17. The copy has a displaced  
leading edge............................. 10-38  
18. The copy has a blurred image. .. 10-39  
19. The copy is foggy.  
(horizontally)............................. 10-39  
20. The copy has poor sharpness. .. 10-40  
21. The copy is blank. .................... 10-41  
22. The copy is solid black............. 10-41  
IV. TROUBLESHOOTING  
flash. ......................................... 10-63  
39. The Jam indicator fails to  
turn off. ..................................... 10-64  
40. The Set Control Card indicator  
fails to turn on........................... 10-64  
41. The Set Control Card indicator  
fails to turn off........................... 10-65  
V. TROUBLESHOOTING FEEDING  
PROBLEMS.......................................... 10-66  
A. Copy Jams ..................................... 10-66  
1. Pick-Up/Feeding Assembly...... 10-67  
2. Fixing/Delivery Assembly......... 10-68  
B. Faulty Feeding................................ 10-69  
1. Double Feeding........................ 10-69  
2. Wrinkles.................................... 10-69  
VI. ARRANGEMENT AND FUNCTIONS  
OF ELECTRICAL PARTS .................... 10-70  
A. Sensors and Switches ................... 10-70  
B. Motors, Fans, Clutches,  
MALFUNCTIONS ................................. 10-42  
A. Copier ............................................. 10-42  
1. E000 ......................................... 10-42  
2. E001 ......................................... 10-43  
3. E002/E003 ............................... 10-44  
4. E004 ......................................... 10-45  
5. E010 ......................................... 10-45  
6. E013 ......................................... 10-46  
7. E030 ......................................... 10-46  
8. E031 ......................................... 10-47  
9. E202 (The keys on the control  
panel fail to operate.) ............... 10-47  
10. E208 ......................................... 10-48  
11. E210 ......................................... 10-48  
12. E220 ......................................... 10-49  
13. E261 ......................................... 10-49  
14. E710/E711 ............................... 10-49  
15. E712 ......................................... 10-50  
16. E717 ......................................... 10-50  
and Solenoids................................. 10-72  
C. Heaters, Lamps, and Others.......... 10-74  
D. PCBs .............................................. 10-76  
E. Variable Resistors, Light-Emitting  
Diodes, and Check Pins by PCB ... 10-77  
x
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. DC Controller PCB ................... 10-77  
2. Power Supply PCB .................. 10-80  
3. Lamp Regulator PCB ............... 10-80  
4. High-Voltage Power Supply  
D. Display Mode [1] ............................ 10-84  
E. I/O Display Mode [2]....................... 10-88  
F. Adjust Mode [3] .............................. 10-92  
G. Function Mode [4] .......................... 10-94  
H. Option Mode [5].............................. 10-95  
I. Counter Mode [6] ........................... 10-97  
J. Application Mode [7]....................... 10-98  
VIII. SELF DIAGNOSIS .............................. 10-99  
A. Copier ............................................. 10-99  
B. ADF .............................................. 10-103  
C. Sorter ............................................ 10-104  
D. Cassette Feeding Module ............ 10-104  
PCB .......................................... 10-81  
VII. SERVICE MODE .................................. 10-82  
A. Outline ............................................ 10-82  
B. Using Service Mode ....................... 10-82  
1. Starting Service Mode.............. 10-82  
2. Selecting Service Mode ........... 10-82  
C. Using Adjust Mode and  
Function Mode................................ 10-83  
APPENDIX  
A. GENERAL TIMING CHART............... A-1  
B. SIGNALS AND ABBREVIATIONS .... A-2  
C. GENERAL CIRCUIT DIAGRAM ........ A-5  
D. SPECIAL TOOLS LIST ...................... A-7  
E. SOLVENTS AND OILS ...................... A-8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1  
GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
This chapter introduces the copier’s features and specifications, shows how to operate the copier, and  
explains how copies are made.  
I. FEATURES .............................................. 1-1  
II. SPECIFICATIONS ................................... 1-2  
A. Copier ................................................. 1-2  
III. NAMES OF PARTS.................................. 1-8  
A. External View ..................................... 1-8  
B. Cross Section ..................................... 1-9  
IV. OPERATING THE MACHINE ................ 1-10  
A. Control Panel.................................... 1-10  
B. User Mode ........................................ 1-12  
V. ROUTINE MAINTENANCE  
(BY THE USER) .................................... 1-14  
VI. PONITS TO NOTE (BY THE USER) ..... 1-15  
VII. IMAGE FORMATION ............................. 1-16  
A. Outline .............................................. 1-16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
I. FEATURES  
1. The copier is designed light in weight (about 42 kg), and compact in size (566 mm wide,  
541mm deep).  
2. The copier turns out as many as 16 copies each minute (A4/LTR).  
3. The addition of the Cassette Feeding Module-C1 (accessory) enables a source of paper  
capable of holding a maximum of 1,050 sheets.  
4. The density may be adjusted to 33 different shades, or in automatic mode (AE).  
5. The use of a photo mode promises faithful reproduction of halftone.  
6. The use of an auto power-off function promises power-saving operation.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
II. SPECIFICATIONS  
A. Copier  
1. Type  
Body  
Desktop  
Copyboard  
Light source  
Lens  
Fixed  
Halogen lamp (120V:200W/230V:220W)  
Lens array  
Photosensitive material  
OPC (30 dia.)  
2. Mechanisms  
Copying  
Charging  
Exposure  
Indirect electrostatic  
Corona  
Slit (moving light source)  
Copy density adjustment Auto or manual  
Development Dry (toner projection)  
Auto  
Front cassette (1 pc.)  
Pick-up  
Manual  
Multifeeder (5 mm deep approx.; about 50 sheets of 80 g/m2 paper)  
Transfer  
Corona  
Separation  
Cleaning  
Fixing  
Curvature + static eliminator  
Blade  
Heat roller (1000 W for 120V model; 1050 W for 230V model)  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
3. Performance  
Original type  
Maximum original size  
Direct  
Sheet, book, 3-D object (2 kg max.)  
A3/279 × 432 mm (11"×17")  
1:1.000  
1:0.5000  
1:0.707  
Reduce I  
Reduce II  
Reduce III 1:0.0816  
Reproduction Reduce IV 1:0.0865  
ratio  
Enlarge I  
1:1.154  
Enlarge II 1:1.224  
Enlarge III 1:1.414  
Enlarge IV 1:2.000  
Zoom  
1:0.500 to 2.000 (in 1% increments)  
Wait time  
First copy  
30 sec or less (at 20°C room temperature)  
5.8 sec or less (A4, Direct, non-AE, cassette)  
999 sheets max.  
Continuous copying  
Copy size  
A3/279×432 mm (11"×17") max. B5R/STMTR min.  
Cassette  
• Plain paper (64 to 80 g/m2)  
A3, B4, A4R, A4, B5R,B5, 279 × 432 mm (11"×17"), LTRR, LTR, LGL  
• Colored paper (recommended by Canon)  
B4, A4  
• Plain paper (64 to 80 g/m2)  
A3, B4, A4R, A4, B5R, B5, A5, 279X432 mm (11"×17"), LTRR,  
LTR, LGL, STMTR  
Copy paper  
type  
Multifeeder  
• Tracing paper (SM-1, GNT80)  
A3, B4, A4R, A4, B5R, B5, A5  
• Transparency (recommended by Canon)  
A4/LTR  
• Colored paper (recommended by Canon)*  
B4, A4  
• Label paper (recommended by Canon)  
A4/LTR  
• Heavy paper (up to 128 g/m2)  
*May be used, but may not feed properly.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
Claws  
Frame  
Used  
Cassette  
55 mm deep (500 sheets of 80 g/m2 paper; 250 sheets if B5)  
100 sheets approx. (plain paper ; 64 to 80 g/m2)  
Copy tray  
Leading edge Direct 2.0 ±1.0 mm  
Trailing edge Direct 2.5 ±1.5 mm  
Non-image  
width  
Left/right  
Direct 2.5 ±2.0 mm  
Auto clear  
Provided (2 min standard; may be changed between 1 and 9 min  
in 1-min increments)  
Auto power-off  
Auto pre-heat  
Accessories  
Provided (30 min standard; may be changed between 10 and 90 min  
in 10-min increments)  
Provided (15 min standard; may be changed between 15 and 90 min  
in 15-min increments)  
• ADF-G1*  
• MS-C1*  
• Cassette Feeding Module-C1  
• Stapler Sorter-L1*  
• Control Card IV N  
• Remote Diagnostic Device II  
*Applies to the NP7161 only.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
4. Others  
Temperature  
Humidity  
7.5° to 32.5°C/45.5° to 90.5°F  
Operating  
conditions  
5% to 80% RH  
Atmospheric  
pressure  
810.6 to 1013.3 hPa (0.8 to 1.0 atm)  
NP7160  
NLB xxxxx  
----  
NP7161  
----  
120V  
Power  
source  
120V (UL)  
127V  
NLD xxxxx  
----  
NLC xxxxx  
230V  
PHQ xxxxx  
PHS xxxxx  
1.5 kW or less  
Maximum  
Standby  
Continuous  
Copying  
Standby  
Power  
consumption  
0.135 kWh (approx.; reference only)  
0.645 kWh (approx.; reference only)  
66 dB or less (sound power level by ISO method)  
40 dB or less (sound power level by ISO method)  
0.05 ppm or less  
Noise  
Ozone (8-hr average)  
Width  
566 mm/22.3 in  
541 mm/21.3 in  
Dimensions Depth  
Height  
389 mm/15.3 in  
NP7160  
NP7161  
42 kg/92.6 lb (approx.)  
Weight  
42 kg/92.6 lb (approx.)  
Keep wrapped, and avoid humidity.  
Copy paper  
Consumables  
Avoid direct sunlight, and store at 40°C, 85% or less.  
Toner  
Specifications subject to change without notice.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
Reproduction mode  
Size  
Copy paper  
A3  
Copies/min  
A3 (297 × 420mm)  
A4 (210 × 297mm)  
B4 (257 × 364mm)  
B5 (182 × 257mm)  
A4R (297 × 210mm)  
B5R (257 × 182mm)  
A3 A4R  
9
A4  
16  
11  
17  
13  
14  
11  
13  
12  
B4  
Direct  
(100%)  
B5  
A4R  
B5R  
A4R  
B5R  
A4R  
I
(70.7%)  
B4 B5R  
B4 A4R  
II  
Reduce  
(81.6%)  
A3 B4  
A4 B5  
A5R A3  
B4  
B5  
A3  
10  
17  
8
III  
(86.5%)  
I
(200%)  
II  
A4R A3  
B5R B4  
A4R B4  
A3  
B4  
B4  
8
9
9
(141.4%)  
Enlarge  
III  
(122.4%)  
IV  
(115.4%)  
B4 A3  
B5 A4  
A3  
A4  
8
11  
Specifications subject to change without notice.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
Reproduction mode  
Size  
Copy paper  
11" × 17"  
LTR  
Copies/min  
11" × 17" (279 × 432mm)  
LTR (297 × 216mm)  
LGL (216 × 356mm)  
LTRR (216 × 297mm)  
11" × 17" LTRR  
9
16  
11  
13  
12  
Direct  
(100%)  
LGL  
LTRR  
I
LTRR  
(64.7%)  
II  
11" × 17" LGL  
LGL LTRR  
LGL  
11  
12  
8
Reduce  
(73.3%)  
III  
LTRR  
(78.6%)  
I
STMTR 11" × 17"  
LTRR 11" × 17"  
LGL 11" × 17"  
11" × 17"  
11" × 17"  
11" × 17"  
(200%)  
II  
8
Enlarge  
(129.4%)  
III  
8
(121.4%)  
Specifications subject to change without notice.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
III. NAMES OF PARTS  
A. External View[1]  
[2]  
[3] [4]  
[5] [7]  
[6]  
[11]  
[12]  
[10]  
[9]  
[8]  
[9] Right door  
[10] Right cover  
[11] Front door  
[12] Cassette  
[5] Upper right cover  
[6] Upper rear cover  
[7] Multifeeder  
[1] Control panel  
[2] Copyboard glass  
[3] Copyboard cover  
[4] Power switch  
[8] Waste toner box  
Figure 1-301  
[1] [2]  
[3]  
[4] [5]  
[6]  
[7]  
[8]  
[9]  
[7] Open/close lever  
[4] Lower delivery cover  
[5] Front fixing cover  
[6] Inside cover  
[1] Copy tray  
[8] Lower inside cover  
[9] Static eliminator  
[2] Upper left cover  
[3] Upper delivery cover  
Figure 1-302  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
B. Cross Section  
1. Copier  
[1]  
[2]  
[3] [4]  
[5]  
[6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15]  
[26]  
[25]  
[24]  
[23] [22] [21] [20]  
[19] [18] [17] [16]  
[1] No. 3 mirror  
[2] No. 2 mirror  
[3] Scanning lamp  
[4] No. 1 mirror  
[5] Copyboard glass  
[6] Lens  
[11] Dust-proofing glass  
[12] Developing cylinder  
[13] No. 4 mirror  
[21] Transfer charging assembly  
[22] Separation static eliminator  
[23] Heat discharging roller  
[24] Lower fixing roller  
[14] No. 5 mirror  
[15] Multifeeder pick-up roller  
[16] Feed roller  
[25] Upper fixing roller  
[26] Delivery roller  
[7] Pre-exposure lamp  
[17] Separation roller  
[18] Vertical path roller  
[19] Pick-up roller  
[8] Primary charging assembly  
[9] Blank exposure lamp  
[10] No. 6 mirror  
[20] Registration roller  
Figure 1-303  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
IV. OPERATING THE MACHINE  
A. Control Panel  
[1]  
[5] [6]  
[8] [9][10] [11]  
[12][13] [14]  
[16][17]  
[18]  
1[9]  
[2] [3]  
[4]  
[7]  
[15]  
[20]  
[21]  
Energy Saver  
Max. 200%  
A4/LTR A3 B5 B4  
A4/LTR B4  
B4 A3 B5 A4/LTR  
1 : 1  
A3 B4 A4/LTR B5  
B4 A4/LTR  
Reset  
Image Combination  
Fit Image  
Photo  
2
3
Stop  
Sort  
1
2
5
8
0
3
6
Auto Paper  
A3/1117  
A4/LTR  
Two-page Separation  
ON/OFF  
Staple-  
Sort  
Start  
4
7
Auto Zoom  
%
Additional  
Functions  
R
A4/LTR  
B4/LGL  
B5  
Group  
A3 A4/LTR B4 B5  
Min. 50%  
U1  
U2  
9
R
B5  
Zoom  
Interrupt  
A
Reduce  
1 : 1  
Enlarge  
Paper Select  
ID  
C
Clear  
[23]  
[24][25] [26][27] [28]  
[22]  
Figure 1-401  
Ref.  
[1]  
Name  
Sorter key*  
Description  
Remarks  
*Requires a sorter or  
stapler sorter.  
Press it to select or deselect Sort, Staple Sort, or  
Group Sort mode.  
Sorter indicator*  
Indicates the selected delivery mode. It remains  
off in non-sort mode.  
[2]  
[3]  
*Requires an ADF.  
2-on-1*/Page  
Separate key  
Press it to select or deselect 2-on-1 or Page  
Separate mode.  
Fit Page key  
Press to select or deselect Fit Page mode. Use  
the mode to make a copy covering all image area  
of the original.  
[4]  
[5]  
[6]  
Photo key  
Press it to select or deselect Photo mode.  
Reduce/Direct/  
Enlarge key  
Press it to select Reduce/Enlarge (default ratio) or  
reset any ratio to Direct.  
Default Ratio indicator Indicates the selected default reproduction ratio.  
Control Card indicator Flashes when the control card is not set properly.  
[7]  
Requires a Control  
Card Unit.  
Jam indicator  
Flashes when a jam occurs.  
[8]  
Toner indicator  
Flashes when toner is running out. It stops  
flashing and remains on when toner runs out  
completely.  
Paper indicator  
Flashes if paper runs out in the selected cassette  
or the manual feed tray (or, when the cassette is  
not set properly).  
Paper Source/Jam  
Indicates the selected cassette or the manual tray;  
flashes the location of a jam, if any. (It also  
[9]  
flashes when a jam occurs in the ADF or when the  
sorter or the right door needs to be checked.)  
* Applies to the NP7161 only  
Table 1-401  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
Ref.  
[10]  
Name  
Description  
Remarks  
Location indicator  
Flashes when the waste toner box needs to be  
replaced. When the case becomes full, it stops  
flashing and remains on.  
Paper Size indicator  
Paper Select key  
Indicates the size of the paper in the cassette  
selected by the Paper Select key.  
[11]  
[12]  
[13]  
*Requires an ADF.  
*Requires an ADF.  
Press it to select Auto Paper Select*, Cassette, or  
Manual Feed Tray mode.  
Copy Count/Ratio  
indicator  
Indicates the copy count/ratio and the selected  
user mode.  
Auto Ratio key*  
Use it to select or deselect Auto Ratio mode, in  
which the best reproduction ratio is automatically  
selected to suit the original and the selected  
paper.  
[14]  
[15]  
[16]  
[17]  
% key  
Press it to indicate the selected reproduction ratio.  
Use it to reset the current copy mode to default.  
Use it to set a copy count or to enter a numeric value.  
Press it to start copying.  
Reset key  
Keypad  
[18] Start key  
[19]  
Stop key  
Press it to stop continuous copying.  
[20] Power Save key  
[21] Power switch  
Press it to select or deselect power save mode.  
Press it to turn on or off the power.  
Copy Density  
[22]  
Slide it to adjust the copy density manually.  
lever  
AE key  
[23]  
Press it to select or deselect AE (auto density  
adjustment) mode.  
Zoom key  
[24]  
Press it to select a reproduction ratio (50% to  
200%) in 1% increments. Hold it down to  
increase/decrease the ratio continuously.  
[25] User Mode key  
Press it to set or change user mode settings.  
Interrupt key  
[26]  
Press it to stop an ongoing copying run to make a  
copy of a different original.  
ID key  
[27]  
Press it after entering an appropriate ID number.  
Press it also after entering a number for ID  
registration.  
Clear key  
[28]  
Press it to reset the copy count to 1 or to clear any  
wrong input when making settings.  
* Applies to the NP7161 only  
Table 1-402  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
B. User Mode  
1. Outline  
The copier provides user modes, which may be changed freely by the user. These modes  
provide the functions shown in the following table.  
Factory settings  
(default)  
Notation  
Item  
Description  
Resetting  
user mode  
Use it to reset new settings made in user  
mode to default settings.  
U00  
Changing auto  
clear time  
Use it to set the auto clear time length  
between 1 an 9 min in 1-min increments.  
Setting it to 0 disables the auto-clear  
function.  
2 min  
U01  
Changing auto  
Use it to select an appropriate auto power-  
power-save time save time length: 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60,  
or 90 min (8 lengths).  
15 min  
30 min  
±0.0%  
U02  
U03  
Changing auto  
power-off time  
Use it to select an appropriate auto power-  
off time length: 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 90  
(8 lengths).  
Fine-adjusting  
Zoom  
Use it to adjust vertical and horizontal  
reproduction ratios over ±5 grades in 0.2%  
increments.  
U04  
U05  
Rang: -1.0% to +1.0% in units of 0.2%  
Turning on/off  
auto cassette  
change  
Use it to turn on/off the auto cassette change ON  
function, in which copying is continued by  
switching cassettes when the selected  
cassette runs out of paper.  
O N : Enable auto cassette change.  
OFF : Disable auto cassette change.  
Turning on/off  
auto sort  
Use it to turn on/off the auto sort function, in ON  
which sorting takes place when making  
multiple copies of multiple originals using  
an ADF.  
U06  
O N : Enable auto sort.  
OFF : Disable auto sort.  
Turning on/off  
ADF jam  
recovery  
Use it to turn on/off auto counting of  
originals in ADF jam recovery.  
O N : Enable auto count.  
OFF  
U07  
U08  
OFF : Disable auto count.  
Cleaning feeder  
Use it to clean the feeder (after placing  
paper in the ADF and pressing the Start  
key).  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
Factory settings  
Notation  
Item  
Description  
(default)  
Changing Page  
Fit mode (ratio)  
Use it to change the reproduction ratio used 93%  
in Page Fit mode between 90% and 99% in  
1% increments.  
U09  
Changing Page  
Fit mode  
(centering)  
Use it to turn on/off the centering function in ON  
Fit Page mode.  
O N : Enable centering.  
U10  
U11  
OFF : Disable centering.  
Changing Page  
Fit mode  
(non-image width)  
Use it to turn on/off the non-image width  
function in Page Fit mode.  
OFF  
O N : Enable (create non-image width).  
OFF : Disable (do not create non-image  
width).  
Correcting  
density  
Use it to select an appropriate standard value 0  
(F5) for manual density adjustment between  
-17 and +6 (24 grades).  
U12  
U13  
Setting special  
paper mode  
Use it to select an appropriate fixing  
temperature control mode for special paper  
when pick-up is from the multifeeder.  
0: Standard  
0
1: Rough surface paper (against poor fixing)  
2: Tracing paper (against high-temperature  
offset)  
Drum cleaning  
mode  
Use it to turn ON/OFF the drum cleaning  
function.  
OFF  
To remove dirt from the surface of the  
photosensitive drum, toner is deposited on  
the surface after copying operation and the  
cleaning blade is used to collect the toner  
together with the dirt. (In addition, LSTR is  
extended by 6.5 sec)  
U14*  
O N : Enable drum cleaning.  
OFF : Disable drum cleaning.  
* If the drum cleaning settings in service mode No. 519 is turned ON.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
V. ROUTINE MAINTENANCE (BY THE USER)  
Instruct the user to clean the following parts at least once a week.  
1. Copyboard Glass  
Wipe with a moist cloth (moistened with water or mild detergent solution); then, dry wipe.  
2. Copyboard Cover  
Wipe it with a moist cloth (moistened with water or mild detergent solution); then, dry wipe.  
3. Primary Charging Assembly  
Pull out and then push in the wire cleaner several times to clean the charging wire.  
4. Transfer Charging Assembly  
Pull out and then push in the wire cleaner several times to clean the charging wire.  
5. Static Eliminator  
If separation jams occur frequently, clean the static eliminator using the special brush.  
(Cleaning need not be as often as every week.)  
6. Waste Toner Box  
If the Waste Toner Box indicator on the control panel flashes or turns on, replace the waste  
toner box.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
VI. POINTS TO NOTE (BY THE USER)  
• Toner Cartridge  
Instruct the user to dispose of any used (empty) toner cartridge according to governmental  
guidelines.  
• Waste Toner Box  
Instruct the user to keep any waste toner box for collection during a servicing visit.  
Caution:  
Do not dispose of the toner cartridge or the waste toner box into fire. Toner can catch  
fire, causing implosion or explosion.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
VII.IMAGE FORMATION  
A. Outline  
The copier is constructed as shown in Figure 1-701.  
Copyboard glass  
Scanning  
lamp  
Lens  
Developing  
assembly  
Blanking exposure  
lamp  
Primary charging  
assembly  
Pre-exposure  
Fixing  
assembly  
lamp  
Pick-up  
(multifeeder)  
Pick-up  
(cassette)  
Static  
eliminator  
Transfer charging  
assembly  
Figure 1-701  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 1 GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
The copier's image formation processes consist of the following eight steps:  
Step 1 Pre-exposure  
Step 2 Primary charging (negative DC)  
Step 3 Image exposure  
Step 4 Development (AC + negative DC)  
Step 5 Transfer (negative DC)  
Step 6 Separation (curvature + static eliminator)  
Step 7 Fixing  
Step 8 Drum cleaning  
Static latent image formation block  
2. Primary charging  
1. Pre-exposure  
3. Image exposure  
4. Development  
5. Transfer  
Flow of copy paper  
Rotation of drum  
8. Drum cleaning  
Multifeeder  
Registration  
7. Fixing  
6. Separation  
Delivery  
Cassette  
Figure 1-702  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
1–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2  
BASIC OPERATION  
This chapter provides outlines of the copier’s various mechanical workings.  
Process speed  
105 mm/s  
I. BASIC MECHANISMS ............................. 2-1  
A. Functional Construction ..................... 2-1  
B. Outline of the Electrical Circuitry........ 2-2  
C. Basic Sequence of Operations .......... 2-4  
D. Main Motor (M1) Control Circuitry...... 2-8  
E. Inputs to the DC Controller ................ 2-9  
F. Outputs from the DC Controller ....... 2-12  
G. Inputs to and Outputs from  
Accessories (1/1) ............................. 2-16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
I. BASIC MECHANISMS  
A. Functional Construction  
The copier can broadly be divided into the following four functional blocks: pick-up,  
feeding, exposure, image formation, and control.  
Control system  
Exposure system  
Copyboard  
Control panel  
Scanning  
assembly  
Optical  
Control circuitry  
assembly  
Image formation system  
Primary  
charging  
Waste  
toner  
container  
Drum  
cleaning  
assembly  
Developing  
assembly  
Photosensitive  
drum  
Multifeeder  
Fixing  
assembly  
Separation  
Transfer  
Pick-up  
control  
Copy  
tray  
assembly  
Cassette 1  
Pick-up feeding assembly  
Cassette 2  
Cassette feeding module  
(*accessory)  
Figure 2-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
B. Outline of the Electrical Circuitry  
The copier's major electrical mechanisms are controlled by the microprocessor on the DC  
controller PCB. The ICs on the DC controller PCB are shown below.  
IC121 (ROM)  
• Controls copying sequence.  
JC113 (gate array)  
• Controls scanning lamp (LA1) error detection.  
• Controls thermistor (TH1, TH2) error detection.  
• Controls triac short circuit error detection.  
• Controls power at time of error.  
• Turns on/off the scanning lamp (LA3).  
• Controls the I/O port.  
IC114 (IPC; NP7161 only)  
• Controls communication with the ADF and the sorter.  
JC116 (RAM)  
• Records settings data (service mode, etc.).  
IC117 (RESET IC)  
• Resets at power-on.  
Figure 2-102 is a block diagram showing the relationship between the copier's major circuits.  
Reference:  
The NP7161 possesses a communications IC (IPC) on its DC controller PCB. The copier  
communicates with the ADF and the sorter using the communications IC on each controller  
PCB (IPC communication) and the communications PCB on the DC controller PCB (IPC  
communication 2).  
2–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
<Sensors>  
<Control>  
<Loads>  
Motors  
DC controller PCB  
Sensors  
Switches  
IC119  
(CPU)  
Toner  
sensor  
Fans  
Clutches  
Solenoids  
Counter  
LEDs  
AE  
sensor  
IC121  
(ROM)  
Thermistors  
IC116  
(RAM)  
IC117  
(RESET)  
Control  
panel  
IC113  
(GA)  
Charging  
assembly  
HVT  
IC114  
(IPC)  
Developing  
cylinder  
Lamp  
Scanning  
regulator  
PCB  
lamp  
Power  
supply  
PCB  
Heaters  
Sensors  
Switches  
Cassette relay  
Cassette feeding  
module  
PCB  
ADF controller PCB  
Sensors  
Switches  
Micro-  
ADF  
IPC  
processor  
Sorter controller PCB  
Sensors  
Switches  
Stapler sorter  
or Sorter  
Micro-  
IPC  
processor  
Figure 2-102  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
C. Basic Sequence of Operations  
1. Basic Sequence of Operations at Power-On  
Power switch  
120°C  
160°C  
ON  
Sequence  
WMUP  
WMUPR  
Green  
STBY  
(flashing)  
Wait indicator  
Fixing heater (H1)  
Main motor (M1)  
Primary charging assembly  
Transfer charging assembly  
Static eliminator  
Developing AC bias  
Developing DC bias  
Pre-exposure lamp (LA2)  
Blank exposure lamp (LA3)  
Scanning lamp (LA1)  
Scanner motor (M2)  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Lens motor (M3)  
Lens home position  
sensor (PS2)  
Mirror motor (M4)  
Mirror home position  
sensor (PS3)  
Figure 2-103  
2–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
Period  
Description  
Remarks  
WMUP  
(warm-up)  
From when the power  
switch is turned on until  
the surface temperature  
of the upper fixing roller  
reaches 120˚C.  
Waits until the upper fixing Moves the lens, mirror,  
roller warms up.  
and scanner to home  
position.  
WMUPR  
From when WMUP ends  
• Evens out the surface  
temperature of the upper  
fixing roller.  
• Stirs the toner inside the  
developing assembly.  
• Discharges copy paper,  
if any, inside the copier.  
Starts copying operation  
when the surface  
temperature of the upper  
fixing roller reaches 140˚C  
if Auto Start has been  
selected.  
(warm-up rotation) until the surface temper-  
ature of the upper fixing  
roller reaches 160˚C.  
STBY  
(standby)  
From when WMUPR ends Waits for a press on an  
until the Copy Start key is operation key  
Turns on Auto Clear  
if no operation key is  
pressed (i.e., resets to  
standard mode after a  
specific period of time).  
pressed. Or, from when  
LSTR ends until the power  
switch is turned off.  
(Start key, etc.).  
Table 2-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
2. Basic Sequence of Operations at Copy Start  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR STBY  
Orange  
Green  
Wait indicator  
Target temperature control  
Fixing heater (H1)  
Main motor (M1)  
Primary charging assembly  
Transfer charging assembly  
Static eliminator  
Developing AC bias  
Developing DC bias  
Pre-exposure lamp (LA2)  
Blank exposure lamp (LA3)  
Scanning lamp (LA1)  
Scanner motor (M2)  
Voltage control  
Partial activation  
FW  
RV  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Lens motor (M3)  
Lens home position  
sensor (PS2)  
Mirror motor (M4)  
Mirror home position  
sensor (PS3)  
Figure 2-104  
2–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
Period  
Description  
Remarks  
INTR  
(initial rotation)  
From when the Start key  
is pressed until the  
scanner starts to move  
forward.  
Stabilizes the drum  
sensitivity in preparation  
for copying operation.  
AER  
(AE rotation)  
From when the Start key  
is pressed until the  
scanner finishes  
Measures the density of  
the original while the  
scanner is moving forward.  
Used only in AE mode.  
measuring densuty.  
SCFW  
While the scanner is  
Uses the scanning lamp to Generates the registration  
shine the original, and signal, and moves the  
(scanner forward) moving forward.  
directs the reflected optical copy paper to the transfer  
image to the photosensitive assembly.  
drum by way of mirrors  
and lenses.  
SCRV  
While the scanner is  
Returns the scanner to  
home position in  
(scanner reverse) moving in reverse.  
preparation for the next  
copying operation.  
LSTR  
From when SCRV ends  
Rids the surface of the  
Discharges the last copy.  
(last rotation)  
until the main motor stops. photosensitive drum of  
charges (surface potential)  
as post-copying operation.  
Table 2-102  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
D. Main Motor (M1) Control Circuitry  
1. Outline  
Figure 2-105 shows the circuit used to control the main motor (M1), and the circuit has the  
following functions:  
• Turning on and off the main motor.  
• Controlling the rotation of the main motor.  
DC controller  
PCB  
Power supply  
PCB  
Main motor  
Clock pulse  
generator  
J209 J601  
+24V  
-4  
-4  
-2  
-1  
-3  
Phase  
control  
drive  
Drive  
current  
J106  
-17  
J212  
-8  
MM DR  
-2  
-1  
-3  
M1  
circuit  
-16  
MM LKDT* -9  
Hall IC output  
Clock pulse  
Reference signal  
Figure 2-105  
2. Operation  
The main motor is a DC motor equipped with a built-in clock pulse generator, which  
generates clock pulses according to the rotation of the motor while the motor rotates. The phase  
control drive circuit matches the phases of the clock pulses and the reference signals to control  
the rotation of the main motor.  
When the main motor drive signal (MM_DR) from the DC controller PCB goes '1', the phase  
control drive circuit turns on, thereby rotating the main motor at a specific speed.  
3. Detecting an Error  
The phase control drive circuit sends the main motor lock detection signal (MM_LKDT*)=0  
to the DC controller PCB as long as the main motor is rotating at a constant speed. If the rotation  
of the main motor becomes irregular for some reason, MM_LKDT* goes '1'.  
If MM_LKDT*=1 continues for 1 sec or more when MM_DR is '1', the DC controller PCB  
will identify the condition as a main motor error, and will immediately stop the main motor and  
indicate "E010" on the control panel.  
2–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
E. Inputs to the DC Controller  
1. Inputs to the DC Controller (1/3)  
DC controller PCB  
J12  
-1  
J103  
-B3  
-B2  
-B1  
+5V  
Scanner home  
position sensor  
When the scanner is at home position, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS1.)  
-2  
SCHP  
PS1  
-3  
J10  
-1  
+5V  
-B6  
-B5  
-B4  
Lens home  
position sensor  
When the lens is at home position, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS2.)  
-2  
LNSHP  
PS2  
PS3  
PS4  
PS5  
PS6  
PS7  
PS8  
PS9  
PS10  
-3  
J11  
-1  
+5V  
-B9  
-B8  
-B7  
Mirror home  
position sensor  
When the mirror is at home position, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS3.)  
-2  
MRRHP  
-3  
J19  
-3  
J40  
J107  
-B10  
-B12  
-B11  
+5V  
-3 -6  
-5 -4  
-4 -5  
Cassette paper  
sensor  
When PS4 has detected paper, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS4.)  
-1  
CSTPDT  
-2  
J17  
-1  
J700  
+5V  
-3 -1  
-2 -2  
-1 -3  
-A3  
-A2  
-A1  
Registration  
paper sensor  
When PS5 has detected paper, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS5.)  
-2  
RGPDT  
-3  
J21  
-1  
J124  
-3  
+5V  
Delivery paper  
sensor  
When PS6 has detected paper, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS6.)  
-2  
-2  
EXITPD  
-3  
-1  
J18  
-3  
J796  
J107  
-A6  
-A8  
-A7  
+5V  
-3 -9  
-5 -7  
-4 -8  
Multifeeder  
paper sensor  
When PS7 has detected paper, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS7.)  
-1  
MLTPD0  
-2  
HVT  
+5V  
Power supply  
PCB  
J34 J302  
J301  
-3  
-1  
-2  
-1  
-3  
-2  
J210  
J212 J106  
Waste toner  
feeding screw  
locked sensor  
-2  
-9  
-15  
-10  
TRQMLDT  
See p. 4-17.  
J742  
-3  
J796  
J107  
-A9  
+5V  
-6 -6  
-8 -4  
-7 -5  
Multifeeder  
paper widh  
sensor 1  
-1  
-A11  
-A10  
MLTPD1  
-2  
See p. 5-9.  
J743  
-3  
+5V  
-9 -3  
-11 -1  
-10 -2  
-A12  
-A14  
-A13  
Multifeeder  
paper widh  
sensor 2  
-1  
MLTPD2  
-2  
Figure 2-106  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
2. Inputs to the DC Controller (2/3)  
DC controller PCB  
J47  
J797  
J48  
-3  
J107  
-B5  
-B7  
-B6  
+5V  
-1 -3  
-3 -1  
-2 -2  
-5 -3  
-7 -1  
-6 -2  
Right door  
open sensor  
When the right door is closed, '1'.  
(When the light-blocking plate is at PS11.)  
-1  
RDOPDT  
PS11  
-2  
HVT  
+5V  
Power supply  
PCB  
J303  
-1  
J301  
J106  
-9  
J210  
J212  
Waste toner  
sensor  
When the waste toner box is identified as  
being fullor the waste toner box is absent,'1'.  
-3  
-1 -10  
-16  
TNFDT  
-2  
J15  
J721  
J720  
J102  
-B3  
-B2  
-B1  
+5V  
-1 -3  
-2 -2  
-3 -1  
-3 -3  
-2 -2  
-1 -1  
-3 -1  
-2 -2  
-1 -3  
When the level of toner drops below a  
specific level, '1'.  
Toner sensor  
TS1  
TNEMP  
Figure 2-107  
2–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
3. Inputs to the DC Controller (3/3)  
DC controller PCB  
J531  
-4 -1  
-3 -2  
J103  
-A4  
-A3  
-A2  
-A1  
+24V  
AE_DATA  
AE_REF  
AE sensor  
See p. 4-21.  
-2 -3  
-1 -4  
J16  
-2  
J110  
-4  
CSTS0  
CSTS1  
CSTS2  
CSTS3  
SW651  
SW652  
SW653  
SW654  
-3  
-3  
Cassette size  
switch PCB  
-4  
-2  
See p. 5-7.  
-5  
-1  
-1  
-5  
J108  
-1  
+5V  
When the temperature of the fixing roller  
increases, the voltage lowers.  
(analog signal)  
TH1  
-2  
-3  
-4  
TH1  
Main  
thermistor  
When the main thermistor is connected to  
the DC controller PCB, '1'.  
TH1_DT  
TH2  
J109  
-1  
TH2  
TH3  
When the temperature of the fixing roller  
increases, the voltage lowers.  
(analog signal)  
Sub  
thermistor  
-2  
J23  
J112  
-1  
-2 -1  
CLTH  
When the temperature of the drum cleaner  
assembly increases, the voltage lowers.  
(analog signal)  
Cleaner  
thermistor  
-1 -2  
-2  
Figure 2-108  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
F. Outputs from the DC Controller  
1. Outputs from the DC Controller (1/4)  
Power supply PCB  
DC controller PCB  
Heater switch  
(SW1) (accessory)  
CB2 CB1  
LF  
J53  
Cassette/Drum  
heater (H2)  
(accessory)  
-2 -2  
-1 -1  
DS1  
J208  
-1  
J105  
-1  
+24V  
GND  
+5VU  
+5VR  
GND  
-2  
-2  
-3  
-3  
J204  
-1  
J52  
Cassette  
heater (H4)  
(accessory)  
-4  
-5  
-2 -2  
-1 -1  
-5  
-4  
-5  
RL  
J212  
J106  
-22  
See p.7-4.  
J54  
+24V -3  
ZRCRSS  
5V_ON  
Mirror heater  
(H3)  
-2 -2  
-1 -1  
-2  
-1  
-23  
-24  
AC_24V_ON  
(accessory)  
J212  
-6  
J106  
-19  
J201  
See p.6-5.  
Fixing heater  
(H1)  
-1 -1  
-2 -2  
AC  
driver  
HEAT_ERR  
HEAT_DR  
-4  
-21  
RL1  
To HVT  
Thermo switch  
(TSW1)  
(J307)  
J501  
J51  
J55  
Scannimg lamp (LA1)  
-1 -1 -1 -1 -1  
-3 -3 -3 -3 -3  
Lamp  
regulator  
PCB  
J203  
Thermal fuse (FU1)  
-4  
-6  
-1  
-3  
+5V  
J503-1  
J211-5  
J212  
-21  
J106  
-4  
See p.4-3.  
-2  
-3  
-4  
-5  
-4  
-3  
-2  
-1  
LMPDR  
-17  
-8  
LMP_PWM  
-19  
-6  
LMPDT  
J307  
J301  
-10  
-3  
J210  
-1  
To RL1  
+24V  
+24V  
+5V  
-1  
-3  
-8  
J212  
-14  
-13  
-12  
-11  
-10  
J106  
-11  
-12  
-13  
-14  
-15  
See p.4-6.  
-4  
-7  
DV_DC_CNT  
DV_DC_DR  
DV_AC_CNT  
DV_AC_DR  
HVT_DR  
-5  
-6  
HVT  
-6  
-5  
-7  
-4  
-8  
-3  
-9  
-2  
Figure 2-109  
2–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
2. Outputs from the DC Controller (2/4)  
DC controller PCB  
Power supply  
PCB  
J601  
-4  
J209  
-4  
+24V  
J212  
-9  
J106  
-16  
-1  
-1  
MM_LKDT*  
See p. 2-8.  
MM_DR  
Main motor  
M1  
-2  
-2  
-8  
-17  
-3  
-3  
J37  
-3  
J104  
-A3  
-A5  
-A2  
-A4  
-A1  
SC_COM  
SC_A  
SC_A*  
SC_B  
SC_B*  
-1  
-4  
-2  
-5  
Scanner motor  
See p. 3-7.  
M2  
J38  
J101  
-A3  
-A1  
-A2  
-A4  
-A5  
-3 -3  
-1 -5  
-2 -4  
-4 -2  
-5 -1  
LNS_COM  
LNS_A  
LNS_A*  
LNS_B  
Lens motor  
Mirror motor  
See p. 3-4.  
See p. 3-4.  
M3  
M4  
LNS_B*  
J39  
J103  
-A7  
-A5  
-A6  
-A8  
-A9  
-3 -3  
-1 -5  
-2 -4  
-4 -2  
-5 -1  
MMR_COM  
MMR_A  
MMR_A*  
MMR_B  
MMR_B*  
Figure 2-110  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
3. Outputs from the DC Controller (3/4)  
DC controller PCB  
J14  
J104  
-B1  
-B2  
-B3  
FM1  
-1 -3  
SCFAN_DR  
SCFAN_DT*  
-2 -2  
Cooling fan 1  
-3 -1  
J20  
FM2  
-1 -3  
-B10  
-B11  
-B12  
EXFAN1_DR  
EXFAN1_DT*  
-2 -2  
Exhaust fan 1  
-3 -1  
See p. 7-2.  
J22  
FM4  
-1 -3  
-B7  
-B8  
-B9  
EXFAN0_DR  
EXFAN0_DT*  
-2 -2  
Exhaust fan 2  
-3 -1  
J123  
-1  
J24  
-1 -3  
FM5  
STFAN0_DR  
STFAN0_DT*  
Sorter kit fan  
(accesory)  
-2 -2  
-3 -1  
-2  
-3  
Power supply  
PCB  
J211  
J29  
-2 -1  
+24V  
-7  
Registration  
roller clutch  
J212  
-22  
J106  
-3  
CL1  
CL2  
CL3  
-1 -2  
-6  
RG_CL*  
+24V  
When '0', CL1 turns on.  
J35  
-2  
J796  
J107  
-A4  
-1 -11  
Feed roller  
clutch  
-1  
-2 -10  
-A5  
FEED_CL* When '0', CL2 turns on.  
J31  
-2  
J797  
+24V  
-1 -7  
-B1  
-B2  
Multifeed  
roller clutch  
-1  
-2 -6  
MLT_CL*  
When '0', CL3 turns on.  
Figure 2-111  
2–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
4. Outputs from the DC Controller (4/4)  
DC controller PCB  
J36  
-2  
J40  
J107  
-B8  
+24V  
-1 -8  
Pick-up  
solenoid  
SL1  
SL2  
-1  
J30  
-2 -7  
-B9  
PU_SL*  
+24V  
When '0', SL1 turns on.  
When '0', SL3 turns on.  
J797  
-2  
-3 -5  
-B3  
-B4  
Multifeed  
solenoid  
-1  
-4 -4  
MLT_SL*  
J33  
J102  
-A11  
+24V  
-2 -1  
Total counter  
CNT1  
CNT2  
-1 -2  
-A10  
TCNT_DR* When '0', CNT1 turns on.  
J32  
+24V  
-3 -1  
-A13  
-A12  
Accessory  
counter  
(accessory)  
-1 -3  
OPCNT_DR* When '0', CNT2 turns on.  
J501  
J104  
-A6  
+24V  
LA2  
LA3  
-1 -2  
Pre-exposure  
lamp  
-2 -1  
-A7  
PREXP_DR* When '0', LA2 turns on.  
J551  
-1 -10  
-3 -8  
-5 -6  
-6 -5  
-7 -4  
-8 -3  
-9 -2  
-10 -1  
-2 -9  
-4 -7  
J101  
-A6  
+24V  
+5V  
-A8  
-A10  
-A11  
-A12  
-A13  
-A14  
-A15  
-A7  
BLK_SD  
BLK_SCK  
Blank exposure  
lamp  
BLK_LCK  
See p. 4-12.  
BLK_DEN*  
BLK_CNDR*  
BLK_PW  
-A9  
Figure 2-112  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
2–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 2 BASIC OPERATION  
G. Inputs to and Outputs from Accessories (1/1)  
DC controller PCB  
J750  
J120  
-1  
J754  
-4 -4 -4  
-2 -2 -2  
-3 -3 -3  
-1 -1 -1  
DF-TXD See the ADF Service Manual.  
DF-RXD  
-3  
-2  
-4  
Accesory power  
supply PCB  
Power supply  
PCB  
J955  
-1  
J752  
-9 -1 -1  
-10 -2 -2  
-11 -3 -3  
-12 -4 -4  
To ADF  
+24V1  
+24V2  
-2  
-3  
GND1  
J951  
GND2  
-1  
J206  
-4  
-1  
-4  
AC  
AC  
-3  
J952  
-1  
J753  
J755  
-9 -1 -1  
-10 -2 -2  
-11 -3 -3  
-12 -4 -4  
+24V1  
+24V2  
GND1  
GND2  
-2  
-3  
-4  
J751  
-4 -4 -4  
-2 -2 -2  
-3 -3 -3  
-1 -1 -1  
J120  
-5  
To Sorter  
ST-TXD See the Sorter Service Manual.  
ST-RXD  
-7  
-6  
-8  
J701  
J122  
To Cassette  
Feeding  
Module-C1  
J104  
-A9  
J790  
-2  
+5V  
-4  
-3  
-1  
-A11  
-A10  
-A8  
To Control  
Card IV N  
CCD*  
CCDT*  
When '0', control card turns on.  
When '0', the card is detected.  
J121  
-2  
J722  
+24V  
+5V  
-7  
-2  
-5  
-4  
-3  
-8  
-6  
-1  
-7  
-4  
See the Remote Diagnostic  
Device II Service Manual.  
AS_TXD  
AS_RXD  
AS_CNTP  
To Remote  
Diagnostic  
Device II  
-5  
-6  
-1  
-3  
-8  
Figure 2-113  
2–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3  
EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
This chapter discusses the principles of operation used for the copier's lens drive unit and scanner drive  
unit. It also explains the timing at which these drive units are operated, and shows how they may be  
disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION ..................... 3-1  
A. Changing the Reproduction Ratio...... 3-1  
II. LENS DRIVE SYSTEM ............................ 3-3  
A. Driving the Lens ................................. 3-3  
III. SCANNER DRIVE SYSTEM.................... 3-6  
A. Outline ................................................ 3-6  
B. Scanner Motor Control Circuit ........... 3-7  
C. Relationship between Scanner Sensor  
and Signals......................................... 3-7  
D. Basic Sequence of Operations  
(scanner) ........................................... 3-8  
E. Scanner Movement in  
Page Separation Mode ...................... 3-9  
IV. OTHERS................................................. 3-10  
A. Detecting the Original Size .............. 3-10  
V. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................. 3-11  
A. Scanner Drive Assembly.................. 3-12  
B. Lens Drive Assembly ....................... 3-18  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION  
A. Changing the Reproduction Ratio  
The reproduction ratio in the axial direction of the photosensitive drum is varied by the lens  
drive system and the mirror drive system, and that in the peripheral direction of the  
photosensitive drum is changed by the scanner drive system.  
The lens drive system uses a lens array and, as shown in Figure 3-101, the lens position and  
the optical length are varied to change the reproduction ratio in the axial direction of the  
photosensitive drum.  
The optical length is varied, as shown in Figure 3-102, by changing the location of the No. 4/  
No. 5 mirror unit.  
The scanner drive system moves the No. 1 mirror relatively faster (in Reduce) or slower (in  
Enlarge) than the photosensitive drum (peripheral speed) to change the reproduction ratio in the  
peripheral direction of the photosensitive drum.  
Note:  
1. In Direct, the speed of the No. 1 mirror is made identical to the peripheral speed of the  
photosensitive drum.  
2. In both Reduce and Enlarge, the optical length is longer than in Direct.  
Direct  
F'  
F
Optical length  
L1  
Reduce  
F'  
F
Optical length  
L2  
Enlarge  
F'  
F
Optical length  
L3  
Figure 3-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
Copyboard glass  
Enlarge/reduce  
Enlarge Reduse  
Lens  
No.4/No.5 mirror unit  
Photosensitive  
drum  
Figure 3-102  
3–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
II. LENS DRIVE SYSTEM  
A. Driving the Lens  
1. Outline  
The lens is driven by the lens motor (M3) and the mirror motor (M4).  
As shown in Figure 3-201, when the lens motor rotates in normal direction, the lens moves in  
the direction of Enlarge by the drive coming through gears and drive belt.  
At this time, the No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit moves by the drive coming from the mirror motor in  
the direction of Enlarge/Reduce according to how much the lens moves (reproduction ratio),  
thereby varying the optical length.  
Mirror motor (M4)  
Mirror motor drive command  
Mirror home position  
sensor (PS3)  
Mirror home position  
detection signal (MRRHP)  
Enlarge/Reduce  
Direct  
DC  
Enlarge  
controller  
PCB  
Reduce  
Lens home position  
sensor (PS2)  
Lens  
motor (M3)  
Lens  
motor  
drive command  
CW  
CCW  
Lens home position detection signal (LNSHP)  
Figure 3-201  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
2. Motor Control Circuit  
The lens motor (M3) and the mirror motor (M4) are 4-phase stepping motors, and are  
controlled by the motor drive power supply signal (COM) and four drive pulse signals (A, B, A*,  
B*) generated by the DC controller PCB.  
The direction of rotation of the motor is switched by changing the timing at which the four  
drive pulse signals (A, B, A*, B*) are generated.  
The motor drive power supply signal (COM) is used to supply +24 V when rotating each  
motor. It is used to provide +5 V when the motors are at rest, thereby ensuring that the lens and  
the No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit remain still against vibration.  
DC controller PCB  
+24V  
J101  
-A3  
-A1  
-A2  
-A4  
-A5  
J38  
_
LNS COM  
-3 -3  
-5 -1  
-4 -2  
-2 -4  
-1 -5  
_
Lens  
motor  
drive  
LNS A  
_
LNS A*  
Lens motor  
M3  
+5V  
_
LNS B  
_
LNS B*  
circuit  
IC119  
(CPU)  
+24V  
+5V  
J103  
-A7  
-A5  
-A6  
-A8  
-A9  
J39  
_
MMR COM  
-3 -3  
-5 -1  
-4 -2  
-2 -4  
-1 -5  
_
Mirror  
motor  
drive  
MMR A  
_
MMR A*  
M4 Mirror motor  
_
MMR B  
_
MMR B*  
circuit  
Figure 3-202  
3–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
3. Moving the Lens  
The lens and the No. 4/ No. 5 mirror unit are moved with reference to the points at which  
the lens home position sensor (PS2) and the mirror home position sensor (PS3) turn on.  
The number of pulses (indicating the positions of the lens and the No. 4/ No. 5 mirror)  
applied to each motor is stored in memory by the microprocessor on the DC controller PCB.  
When the lens and the No. 4/ No. 5 mirror unit need to be moved, the appropriate number of  
pulses that suits the selected reproduction ratio is generated.  
When the lens and the No. 4/ No. 5 mirror unit need to be moved in the direction of  
reduction (e.g., from Direct to Reduce), each motor is rotated in reverse first to move the lens  
and the No. 4/ No. 5 mirror unit past the position found for the selected reproduction ratio.  
Thereafter, the motors are rotated in normal direction so as to move the lens and the No. 4/ No. 5  
mirror unit to their appropriate positions. Ending the motor rotation when they are rotating in  
normal direction ensures accurate positioning of the lens and the No. 4/ No. 5 mirror unit.  
Power switch  
ON  
Reduce  
key ON  
Enlarge  
key ON  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
WMUP  
WMUPR  
STBY  
INTR  
*
*
*
*
Scanner motor (M2)  
Lens motor (M3)  
Mirror motor (M4)  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Lens home position  
sensor (PS2)  
Mirror home position  
sensor (PS3)  
: Motor CW/sensor ON  
: Motor CCW  
*Length varies depending on the selected reproduction ratio.  
Figure 3-203  
The copier enables adjustment of the lens or the No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit home position in  
service mode.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
III. SCANNER DRIVE SYSTEM  
A. Outline  
The scanner is driven by the scanner motor (M2)  
As shown in Figure 3-301, when the scanner motor rotates in reverse direction, the scanner  
moves forward by the drive coming through the gears, drive belt, and cable. The scanner motor is  
rotated in the opposite direction to move the scanner in reverse.  
The speed of rotation of the scanner motor when the scanner is moved forward is varied  
according to the selected reproduction ratio. The speed when the scanner is moved in reverse,  
however, is the same regardless of the selected reproduction ratio—it is about 2.5 times the speed  
used in Direct when the scanner is moved forward.  
The distance over which the scanner is moved varies according to the length of copy paper  
and the selected reproduction ratio.  
DC controller PCB  
Scanner  
motor (M2)  
CW  
CCW  
Scanner home  
position sensor  
Foward  
(PS1)  
Reverse  
Figure 3-301  
3–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
B. Scanner Motor Control Circuit  
The scanner motor (M2) is a 4-phase stepping motor, and is controlled by four pulse signals  
(SC_A, SC_B, SC_A*, SC_B*) generated by the DC controller PCB.  
The scanner motor is turned on/off and its direction of rotation are controlled by changing  
the timing at which these four pulse signals are generated. The speed of rotation, on the other  
hand, is controlled by switching the current supplied to the scanner motor.  
DC controller PCB  
+24V  
J104  
-A3  
-A5  
-A2  
-A4  
-A1  
J37  
-3  
-1  
-4  
-2  
-5  
SC_COM  
SC_A  
SC_A*  
SC_B  
Scanner  
motor  
M2  
SC_B*  
Scanner  
motor  
control  
circuit  
IC119  
(CPU)  
(IC117)  
Figure 3-302  
C. Relationship between Scanner Sensor and Signals  
Scanner  
Sensor  
Signal  
SCHP  
Description  
Foward  
Reverse  
• The scanner is at home position.  
• The scanner has reached home position.  
Scanner  
home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Table 3-301  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
D. Basic Sequence of Operations (scanner)  
The scanner is moved forward over a distance determined by the microprocessor based on  
the selected paper size, reproduction ratio, and copying mode.  
The microprocessor computes the dimensions of the original in reference to the selected  
paper size and reproduction ration to determine how much the scanner should be moved forward.  
Power switch  
ON  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
WMUP  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR STBY  
FW  
RV  
Scanner motor (M2)  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Scanning lamp (LA1)  
Figure 3-303  
3–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
E. Scanner Movement in Page Separation Mode  
Start key Leading edge of  
Leading edge of Leading edge of  
ON 1st page (original) 1st page (original) 2nd page (original)  
Sequence  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW1 SCRV2  
I
SCFW2  
II  
SCRV2  
LSTR  
III  
FW  
RV  
Scanner motor (M2)  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
18mm  
18mm  
Scanning lamp (LA1)  
Figure 3-304  
I, II, and III shown in Figure 3-304 are controlled by the microprocessor on the DC controller  
PCB with reference to the wait position of the scanner.  
The length from wait position to the leading edge is 18 mm. The microprocessor determines  
how much the scanner should be moved (including the distance to the leading edge) according to  
the selected reproduction ratio and the original size or cassette size.  
I, II : The distance over which the scanner is moved forward for the 1st page is determined  
according to the selected reproduction ratio and the original size or cassette size.  
III : The distance over which the scanner is moved forward is determined as follows: the  
microprocessor divides the detected original size by 2, and assumes the result of the  
division to be the middle of the original (assuming the middle to be the leading edge  
of the 2nd page).  
If original size detection is not performed, the microprocessor uses the cassette size when  
determining the distance over which the scanner should be moved.  
Reference:  
The copier does not require paper size registration for the multifeeder. For this reason, it  
cancels Page Separate mode if the Start key is pressed after selecting the multifeeder.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
IV. OTHERS  
A. Detecting the Original Size  
1. Outline  
The NP7161 is equipped with auto paper selection and auto reproduction selection  
functions, and these functions require identification of the size of originals.  
To enable identification, the copier uses the following:  
• original size detection by the ADF (NP7161)  
2. Detection of the Original Size by the ADF  
The size of originals is detected when originals are fed by the ADF. (For details, see the  
ADF Service Manual.)  
3–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
V. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY  
The copier may be disassembled and assembled as shown here. Pay attention to the copier's  
mechanical characteristics along with the steps for disassembly/assembly.  
Important:  
1. Turn off the power and disconnect the power plug to ensure safety whenever disassembling/  
assembling the copier.  
2. Unless otherwise noted, assemble the parts by reversing the steps used to disassemble them.  
3. Identify the screws by type (length, diameter) to avoid use in the wrong location.  
4. Use a washer where needed. The mounting screws used for the grounding wire and varistor  
come with a washer to ensure electric continuity. Do not forget to use these washers.  
5. As a rule, do not operate the copier with any of its parts removed.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
A. Scanner Drive Assembly  
1. Removing the Scanner Motor  
1) Remove the rear upper cover.  
2) Disconnect the connector [1] and the two  
mounting screws [2].  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 3-501  
[A]  
3) Slide the scanner motor [3] to the right to  
detach from the motor mount; then, move  
it to the cut-off [A] to remove.  
[3]  
Figure 3-502  
3–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
2. Removing the Scanner Drive Cable  
1) In standby state, press the Reduce key so  
that the lens and the No.4 /No.5 mirror  
unit move to 70% reproduction position.  
2) Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
the power plug.  
Caution:  
Whenever you need to perform  
disassembly/assembly work, be sure to  
turn it off and disconnect its power  
plug.  
3) Remove the lens hood.  
(See p. 3-20.)  
4) Remove the scanner motor.  
(See p. 3-12.)  
5) Remove the control panel  
(See p. 7-13.)  
6) Remove the upper left cover.  
(See p.7-11.)  
7) Remove the upper right cover.  
(See p.7-10.)  
8) Detach the lock support [1] from the  
connector base [2].  
9) Remove the two mounting screws [3], and  
pull out the connector base [2].  
[3]  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 3-503  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
[6]  
[4]  
[5]  
10) Remove the three mounting screws [4],  
and detach the motor base [5] and the  
timing belt [6].  
Caution:  
When detaching the motor base, be  
sure to mark its position at its four  
corners. When mounting it, on the  
other hand, be sure to refer to these  
markings.  
Figure 3-504  
[7]  
[7]  
11) Holding the bent [A], pull the scanner  
until it reaches the hole [B]; then, remove  
the two screws [7].  
[B]  
[A]  
Figure 3-505  
[9]  
12) Remove the two tension springs [8], and  
detach the scanner drive cable (front) [9]  
and the scanner drive cable (rear) [10].  
[10]  
[8]  
Figure 3-506  
3–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
3. Routing the Scanner Drive Cable  
Route the scanner drive cable following the sequence indicated in Figure 3-507, i.e., [1]  
through [7].  
Be sure to adjust the mirror position and the tension as indicated later after routing the  
scanner drive cable.  
[3]  
[4]  
Secure temporarily.  
[1]  
Steel  
ball  
Wind 11 times.  
[2]  
[6]  
[5]  
[2]  
[7]  
[6]  
Figure 3-507  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
4. Adjusting the Position of the Mirror  
Be sure to adjust the position of the mirror  
as follows after you have mounted the  
scanner drive cable.  
1) Keep the mirror positioning tool nearby.  
Arrange the mirror positioning tool (FY9-  
3009-050) as shown to adapt it to the  
copier.  
Figure 3-508b (Front)  
Figure 3-508a (Rear)  
2) Fit the mirror positioning tool [1] to the  
No. 1 mirror base and the No. 2 mirror  
base (both front and rear).  
3) Tighten the mounting screw [2] on the  
cable metal fixing of the No. 1 mirror  
base (both front and rear).  
[2]  
[1]  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 3-509a (Rear)  
Figure 3-509b (Front)  
4) Detach the mirror positioning tool.  
3–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
5. Adjusting the Tension of the  
Scanner Drive Cable  
Be sure to adjust the tension as follows  
after routing the scanner drive cable.  
1) Move the scanner to home position.  
2) Pull the center of the scanner drive cable  
with a spring gauge about 10 mm. At this  
time, adjust the position [A] of the tension  
spring [1] so that the reading of the spring  
gauge is 95 ±15 g.  
[A]  
[1]  
[1]  
10mm  
10mm  
Figure 3-511  
Figure 3-510  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
B. Lens Drive Assembly  
1. Removing the Lens Drive Motor  
1) Remove the copyboard glass. (See p.7-14)  
2) Holding the bend [A], slide out the  
scanner as far as the cut-off [B].  
[B]  
[A]  
[B]  
Figure 3-512  
3) Remove the inside cover and the delivery  
upper cover. (See p.7-11)  
4) Disconnect the connector [1].  
[1]  
Figure 3-513  
5) Remove the two screws [2], and remove  
the lens motor [3].  
[2]  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 3-514  
3–18  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
2. Removing the Mirror Motor  
1) While the copier is in standby state, press  
the Enlarge key to move the lens and the  
No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit to 200% position.  
2) Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
the power plug.  
Caution:  
Whenever you are disassembling/  
assembling the copier, be sure to turn  
off the power switch and disconnect  
the power plug.  
3) Remove the copyboard glass. (See p.7-14)  
4) Remove the developing assembly.  
(See p.4-37)  
5) Remove the drum unit. (See p.4-28)  
6) Remove the upper right cover. (See p.7-  
10)  
7) Disconnect the connector [1].  
[1]  
Figure 3-515  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
3–19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 3 EXPOSURE SYSTEM  
8) Remove the two mounting screws [2], and  
remove the lens hood [3].  
[2]  
Caution:  
When mounting the lens hood, take  
care not to trap the wire.  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 3-516  
[5]  
9) Remove the two mounting screws [4], and  
remove the mirror motor [5].  
[4]  
Figure 3-517  
3–20  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4  
IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
This chapter discusses the principles of how images are formed. It also explains the timing at which the  
various units involved in image formation are operated, and shows how they may be disassembled/  
assembled and adjusted.  
I. OUTLINE OF THE PROCESSES............ 4-1  
A. Outline ................................................ 4-1  
B. Basic Sequence of Operations  
C. Monitoring the Waste Toner  
Feeding Screw ................................. 4-17  
D. Monitoring the Waste Toner Box ..... 4-18  
E. Control by the Cleaner Thermistor... 4-20  
F. Auto Density Adjustment (AE) ......... 4-21  
III. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................. 4-23  
A. Scanning Lamp Assembly ............... 4-24  
B. Exposure Assembly ......................... 4-26  
C. Drum Unit ......................................... 4-28  
D. Primary Charging Assembly ............ 4-30  
E. Transfer Charging Assembly ........... 4-31  
F. Charging Wire .................................. 4-32  
G. Developing Assembly....................... 4-37  
(image formation system) .................. 4-2  
C. Controlling the Intensity of the  
Scanning Lamp .................................. 4-3  
D. Controlling the Primary/Transfer Bias .. 4-6  
E. Controlling the Developing/Separation  
Static Eliminator Bias ......................... 4-7  
F. Controlling the Blank Exposure Lamp ... 4-12  
II. DEVELOPING ASSEMBLY/DRUM  
CLEANER ASSEMBLY .......................... 4-14  
A. Outline .............................................. 4-14  
B. Detecting and Controlling  
the Level of Toner ............................ 4-16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF THE PROCESSES  
A. Outline  
Figure 4-101 shows the copier's basic construction in reference to image formation. Image  
formation consists of the following functions:  
• Scanning lamp control  
• Primary corona current control  
• Transfer control current control  
• Separation static eliminator bias control  
• Developing bias control  
• Blank exposure lamp control  
Copy board glass  
Lamp regulator  
PCB  
No.2  
mirror  
Lens  
No.1  
Scanning lamp (LA1)  
mirror  
No.4 mirror  
No.3  
No.6  
mirror  
mirror  
AE sensor  
Pre-  
exposure  
Blank  
exposure  
No.5 mirror  
lamp (LA2) lamp (LA3)  
Developing  
assembly  
Primary  
corona  
assembly  
Static  
Transfer  
eliminator  
corona  
assembly  
HVT  
DC controller PCB  
Figure 4-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
B. Basic Sequence of Operations (image formation system)  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR STBY  
Main motor (M1)  
Primary charging assembly  
Developing DC bias  
Voltage control  
Developing AC bias  
Transfer charging assembly  
Static eliminator  
Pre-exposure lamp (LA2)  
Blank exposure lamp (LA3)  
Scanning lamp (LA1)  
Partial activation  
Figure 4-102  
4–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
C. Controlling the Intensity of the Scanning Lamp  
1. Outline  
Figure 4-103 shows the circuit used to control the intensity of the scanning lamp, and the  
circuit has the following functions:  
1. Turning on/off the scanning lamp  
2. Controlling the intensity of the scanning lamp  
• controlling the light to a specific intensity against fluctuations in power supply voltage  
DC controller  
PCB  
Power supply  
PCB  
Lamp regulator  
PCB  
Scanning lamp  
(LA1)  
J203  
-1  
J501  
-4  
J501  
-1  
IC119  
(CPU)  
RL  
Drive  
circuit  
-3  
-6  
-3  
Thermal fuse  
(FU1)  
+24V  
J106  
-24  
J106  
Error  
detection  
circuit  
AC_24V_ON  
-24  
J211  
-5  
-4  
J503  
-1  
+5V  
J106  
-4  
J212  
-21  
LMPDR  
-2  
Lamp  
ON  
detection  
Control  
circuit  
LMP_PWM  
LMPDT  
-8  
-6  
-17  
-19  
-3  
-2  
-1  
-3  
-4  
-5  
IC113  
Figure 4-103  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
2. Operation  
a. Turning On/Off the Scanning Lamp  
When the scanning lamp drive signal (LMPDR) is ‘0’, the output of the control circuit goes  
‘0’, keeping the drive circuit from turning on and therefore not supplying the scanning lamp  
(LA1) with AC power.  
When LMPDR is ‘1’, the output of the control circuit will be ‘1’, turning on the drive circuit  
and thereby supplying the scanning lamp (LA1) with AC power.  
b. Controlling the Intensity of the Scanning Lamp  
The intensity of the scanning lamp is increased/decreased by controlling the voltage of the  
power supplied to the scanning lamp according to the level of the pulse width modulation signal  
(LMP_PWM) from the DC controller PCB.  
LMP_PWM varies the pulse duty between 10% and 90% to suit the selected reproduction  
ratio so as to control the voltage of the power supplied to the scanning lamp as shown in Table 4-  
101 (actual value).  
t
Pulse duty (%) = t / T x 100  
T
Figure 4-104  
Power supply  
Pulse duty  
10 to 90%  
10 to 90%  
DC output  
45 to 80V  
98 to 175V  
120V  
230V  
Table 4-101  
c. Detecting the Activation of the Scanning Lamp  
The control circuit on the lamp regulator PCB generates the drive detection signal  
(LMPDT) at all times while the scanning lamp remains on, and sends the signal to the lamp  
activation detection IC (IC113) on the DC controller PCB.  
If the scanning lamp remains on for 21 sec or more, the error detection circuit will cause the  
AC_24V_ON signal to go ‘0’, thereby cutting the supply of AC power to the lamp regulator  
PCB.  
If an error is identified in the scanning lamp, the DC controller PCB will cut the AC power  
to the lamp regulator and, at the same time, will indicate ‘E220’ on the control panel.  
4–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
3. Protection Mechanisms  
To prevent malfunction of the scanning lamp (LA1), the copier is equipped with a fuse  
(FU1).  
If the temperature around the scanning lamp increases abnormally (about 141°C or more)  
because of a short circuit or the like, the thermal fuse (FU1) will melt to cut the power to the  
scanning lamp.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
D. Controlling the Primary/Transfer Bias  
1. Outline  
Figure 4-108 shows the circuit used to control the primary/transfer bias, and the circuit has  
the following functions:  
1. Turning on/off the primary/transfer bias  
2. Controlling the grid bias to a specific voltage  
3. Controlling the primary shield current to a specific current  
To eliminate the effects of changes in the environment to corona charging, the output to the  
primary charging assembly is controlled by controlling the shield current to a specific current.  
The primary/transfer bias is turned on/off using the following signal from the DC controller  
PCB.  
• HVT_DR (HVT drive command)  
DC controller  
PCB  
Power supply  
PCB  
HVT  
Transformer  
J106 J212  
-15 -10  
HVT DR  
J210  
-3  
J301  
-8  
Oscillation  
control circuit  
_
Pr  
Tr  
Short circuit/noload  
detection circuit  
Reference  
Current  
voltage circuit  
detection circuit  
Figure 4-108  
2. Turning On/Off the Primary/Transfer Bias  
a. When the primary/transfer bias is off,  
• When HVT_DR is 0,  
Oscillation control circuit turns off  
Primary/transfer high-voltage transformer turns off  
b. When the primary/transfer bias is on,  
• When HVT_DR is 1,  
Oscillation control circuit turns on  
Primary/transfer high-voltage transformer turns on  
4–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
E. Controlling the Developing/Separation Static Eliminator Bias  
1. Outline  
Figure 4-109 shows the circuit used to control the developing/static eliminating bias, and the  
circuit has the following functions:  
1. Turning on/off the developing DC bias  
2. Turning on/off the developing AC bias/separation static eliminator bias  
3. Controlling the developing DC bias to a specific voltage to suit copy density  
The above control mechanisms are driven by the following signals:  
_
_
• DV AC DR (developing AC bias drive signal)  
_
_
• DV AC CNT (developing AC bias control signal)  
_
_
• DV DC DR (developing DC bias drive signal)  
_
_
• DV DC CNT (developing DC bias control signal)  
Power supply  
PCB  
DC controller  
PCB  
HVT  
Transformer  
J210 J301  
J106 J212  
-13 -12  
Frequency  
switching circuit  
Oscillation  
circuit  
-5  
-6  
_
_
DV AC CNT  
Control  
circuit  
Amplifier  
circuit  
-4  
-7  
-14  
-11  
_
_
DV AC DR  
Short circuit  
detection circuit  
Reference  
Voltage  
voltage circuit  
detection circuit  
Dev  
Transformer  
Sp  
-6  
-7  
-5  
-4  
-12  
-13  
Oscillation  
control circuit  
_
_
DV DC DR  
-11  
-14  
_
_
DV DC CNT  
Voltage  
Short circuit  
detection circuit  
detection circuit  
Transformer  
Oscillation  
control circuit  
Voltage  
Short circuit  
detection circuit  
detection circuit  
Figure 4-109  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
2. Turning On/Off the Developing DC Bias  
a. Turning On/Off the Developing DC Bias  
• When DV_DC_DR is 0,  
Oscillation control circuit turns off  
DC high-voltage transformer turns off  
The above condition deprives the developing cylinder of developing DC bias.  
• When DV_DC_DR is 1,  
Oscillation control circuit turns on  
DC high-voltage transformer turns on  
The above condition supplies the developing cylinder with developing DC bias.  
b. Control Timing  
As shown in Figure 4-110, a specific developing DC bias (-300 V) is applied to the  
developing cylinder to prevent adhesion of excess toner to the photosensitive drum when copies  
are not being made.  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR STBY  
Voltage  
control  
Developing DC bias  
Developing AC bias  
Figure 4-110  
4–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
3. Turning On/Off the Developing AC Bias/Separation Eliminator Bias  
a. Turning On/Off the Developing AC Bias  
• When DV_AC_DR is 0,  
control circuit turns off  
oscillation circuit turns off  
amplification circuit turns off  
AC high-voltage transformer turns off  
The above condition deprives the developing cylinder of developing AC bias.  
• When DV_AC_DR is 1,  
control circuit turns on  
oscillation circuit turns on  
amplification circuit turns off  
AC high-voltage transformer turns on  
The above condition supplies the developing cylinder with AC bias.  
b. Turning On/Off the Separation Static Eliminator  
• When DV_AC_DR is 0,  
oscillation control circuit turns off  
high-voltage transformer turns off  
The above condition deprives the static eliminator of separation static eliminator bias.  
• When DV_AC_DR is 1,  
oscillation control circuit turns on  
high-voltage transformer turns on  
The above condition supplies the static eliminator with separation static eliminator bias.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
4. Controlling the Developing DC Bias to a Specific Voltage to Suit Copy Density  
While copies are being made, developing AC bias and developing DC bias are applied to the  
developing cylinder. The developing AC bias is 1400 Vp-p, and the developing DC bias may be  
varied by sliding the Copy Density lever on the control panel.  
When the Copy Density lever on the control panel is slid, the CPY_DNS signal will vary  
between 1 and 5 V. The developing DC bias will then vary between -110 and -550 V.  
Normally, the optimum image is obtained when the developing DC bias is set at -270 V  
(CPY_DNS is 2.45V).  
_
(V)  
CPY DNS  
Developing  
DC bias (V)  
-600  
-500  
-400  
-300  
-200  
-100  
5
4
3
2
1
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F9  
Darker  
Copy density  
Lighter  
Figure 4-111  
4–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
_
Copy density  
F1  
Developing DC bias [V]  
-110  
CPY DNS [V]  
1.00  
1.09  
1.18  
1.27  
1.36  
1.45  
1.54  
1.63  
1.72  
1.81  
1.91  
2.00  
2.09  
2.18  
2.27  
2.36  
2.45  
2.54  
2.63  
2.72  
2.81  
2.90  
3.00  
3.16  
3.32  
3.48  
3.64  
3.86  
4.09  
4.32  
4.55  
4.77  
5.00  
F1.25  
F1.5  
F1.75  
F2  
F2.25  
F2.5  
F2.75  
F3  
F3.25  
F3.5  
F3.75  
F4  
F4.25  
F4.5  
F4.75  
F5  
F5.25  
F5.5  
F5.75  
F6  
F6.25  
F6.5  
F6.75  
F7  
F7.25  
F7.5  
F7.75  
F8  
F8.25  
F8.5  
F8.75  
F9  
-120  
-130  
-140  
-150  
-160  
-170  
-180  
-190  
-200  
-210  
-220  
-230  
-240  
-250  
-260  
-270  
-280  
-290  
-300  
-310  
-315  
-330  
-347.5  
-365  
-382.5  
-400  
-425  
-450  
-475  
-500  
-525  
-550  
Table 4-102  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
F. Controlling the Blank Exposure Lamp  
1. Outline  
The blank exposure lamp is an LED array (40 built-in LEDs), and its activation is controlled  
by a static method.  
All LEDs of the blank exposure lamp are turned on while the photosensitive drum is rotating  
and, in addition, the scanner is not exposing an original so as to prevent adhesion of excess toner  
to the photosensitive drum. (The farthest LED (each at front and rear) is kept on at all times as  
long as the photosensitive drum is rotating.)  
The charges on the photosensitive drum are removed in appropriate widths according to  
reproduction ratios and paper sizes while the scanner is exposing an original, thereby preventing  
adhesion of unwanted toner.  
The copier turns on/off the ten LEDs at the center using the blank exposure lamp center  
activation signal (BLK_CNDR*), and controls the 15 LEDs (each at front and rear) by means of  
serial data communication using the following signals:  
• blank exposure lamp serial data signal (BLK_SD)  
• blank exposure lamp serial data clock signal (BLK_SCK)  
• blank exposure lamp serial data latch signal (BLK_LCK)  
• blank exposure lamp drive enable signal (BLK_DEN*)  
• blank exposure lamp power supply line (BLK_PW)  
DC controller PCB  
J101  
Blank exposure lamp (LA3)  
J551  
-10  
+24V  
-A6  
+5V  
-A8  
-8  
-6  
-5  
-4  
-3  
-7  
LED circuit  
(40 pcs)  
_
-A10  
-A11  
-A12  
-A13  
-A9  
BLK SD  
_
BLK SCK  
Control  
circuit  
Center  
(10 pcs)  
_
BLK LCK  
_
BLK DEN*  
_
-A14 BLK CNDR* -2  
_PW  
-A15  
-A7  
BLK  
-1  
-9  
Figure 4-112  
4–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
2. Turning On the Blank Exposure Lamp in Reduce Mode  
While the original is being illuminated in Reduce mode, as many LEDs (both front and rear)  
as suited to the selected reduction ratio are turned on to blank out the non-image widths on the  
photosensitive drum regardless of the selected paper size.  
3. Turning On the Blank Exposure Lamp in Direct/Enlarge Mode  
While the original is being illuminated in Direct/Enlarge mode, as many LEDs (both front  
and rear) as suited to the selected paper size (Table 4-101) are turned on to blank out the non-  
image widths on the photosensitive drum.  
LEDs (number of)  
Paper size  
Front  
1
Rear  
1
A3, A4  
279 × 432mm (11"×17"), LTR  
3
3
B4, B5  
5
5
A4R, A5, LGL, LTRR  
9
9
B5R  
A5R  
13  
15  
13  
15  
Table 4-103  
4. Turning On the Blank Exposure Lamp in Multifeeder Mode  
When copies are made on paper picked up from the multifeeder, the blank exposure lamp is  
turned on to suit the paper width obtained by combinations of the states of the multifeeder paper  
width sensors 1 and 2 (PS9, 10); see p. 5-9.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
II. DEVELOPING ASSEMBLY/DRUM CLEANER  
ASSEMBLY  
A. Outline  
The developing assembly and the drum cleaner are rotated by the drive from the main motor  
(M1) through drive gears.  
The level of toner inside the developing assembly is monitored by the toner sensor (TS1);  
when the amount drops below a specific level, the copier turns on or flashes the Toner indicator  
on the control panel.  
The drum cleaner assembly collects waste toner using the cleaning blade, and moves it to the  
waste toner case using the waste toner feeding screw. The waste toner feeding screw locked  
detection sensor (PS8) serves to monitor the rotation of the waste toner feeding screw.  
The level of the waste toner inside the waste toner case is monitored by the waste toner  
sensor; when the amount of the waste toner exceeds a specific level, the copier flashes the Waste  
Toner indicator on the control panel.  
The cleaner thermistor (TH3) serves to detect overheating of the drum cleaner assembly.  
Cleaning blade  
Waste toner  
feeding screw  
Developing assembly  
Waste toner feeding  
screw locked sensor  
Waste toner  
sensor  
PS8  
TS1  
TH3  
M1  
Main motor  
DC controller PCB  
Figure 4-201  
4–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
The copier is designed to collect more waste toner than existing models, and is equipped with  
a paddle at the bottom of the waste toner box.  
The paddle is linked to the movement of the cassette, and is designed to tap on the bottom of  
the waste toner box to even out the toner inside it.  
Waste toner assembly  
Paddle  
Waste toner  
assembly  
Paddle  
Cassette  
Waste toner  
assembly  
Paddle  
Figure 4-202  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
B. Detecting and Controlling the Level of Toner  
The toner inside the developing assembly is monitored by the toner sensor (TS1).  
The toner sensor uses a piezoelectric oscillator which oscillates in the absence of toner over  
the sensor at several kHz and sends an oscillation signal (TNEMP) to the DC controller PCB. In  
the presence of toner over the sensor, on the other hand, the weight will prevent oscillation.  
AMP  
Output  
TNEMP  
Integration  
circuit  
Piezoelectric oscillator  
Figure 4-203  
The copier detects the absence of toner in two stages.  
The DC controller PCB monitors the output of the toner sensor at all times as long as the  
main motor is rotating. If the sum of periods of the toner absent signal is 70 sec (consecutive two  
periods), it will identify the condition as a condition preceding the absence of toner and will flash  
the Toner indicator on the control panel.  
Thereafter, if the period of the toner absent signal reaches 180 sec or more, the DC controller  
PCB will assume the condition to be the absence of toner, and will stop flashing the Toner  
indicator to keep it on. At this time, the copy being made is processed as would a normal copy  
and discharged, and then the operation will be stopped.  
Sequence  
T1  
T2  
T1  
T2  
T1  
Toner sensor (TS1)  
Toner absent  
Figure 4-204  
Toner indication  
Flashing  
On  
Conditions  
Copying  
>
=
(T1+T2) or (T2+T1)  
T1 or T2  
70sec  
Possible  
No possible  
>
180sec  
=
Table 4-201  
Note:  
When the DC controller identifies a condition preceding the absence of toner, there is  
likely to be as much as 10 g of toner inside the developing assembly. In terms of A4  
copies, about 200 copies may be made without the addition of toner.  
4–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
C. Monitoring the Waste Toner Feeding Screw  
If the waste toner inside the drum cartridge cakes and, as a result, hinders the rotation of the  
waste toner feeding screw, waste toner can start to leak from the pipe. To prevent such a  
problem, the copier is equipped with a waste toner feeding screw detection mechanism  
constructed as shown in Figure 4-206.  
The waste toner feeding screw is linked with a spring clutch and a flag, and is rotated by the  
engagement of the spring clutch with the gear A.  
The rotation of the flag is monitored by the waste toner feeding screw sensor (PS8) at all  
times while the main motor (M1) is rotating.  
When the waste toner feeding screw locks, the spring clutch is subjected to force in the axial  
direction and moves in the direction of the arrow, causing the flag to stop rotating. If the waste  
toner feeding screw lock signal (TRQMLDT) remains unchanged for 0.5 sec or more, the DC  
controller PCB will assume that the waste toner feeding screw became locked, and will  
immediately indicate ‘E013’ on the control panel and stop responding to a press on the Start key.  
Main motor drive command  
DC controller PCB  
Waste toner feeding screw locked detection signal (TRQMLDT)  
Flag  
PS8  
Cleaning blade  
Waste toner feeding  
screw  
Spring clutch  
Gear A  
M1  
Photosensitve drum  
Figure 4-205  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
D. Monitoring the Waste Toner Box  
The copier monitors the waste toner box in two levels.  
The amount of waste toner inside the waste toner box is checked by the waste toner sensor.  
The waste toner sensor is a pair of photosensors (light-emitting cell and light-receiving cell), and  
is designed to generate the waste toner full detection signal (TNFDT) when waste toner blocks  
the light between the two photosensors.  
The DC controller PCB monitors the state of the waste toner sensor at all times; when the  
voltage of the waste toner full detection signal (TNFDT) drops below the reference voltage, it  
will identify the condition as “pre-waste toner full condition” and will flash the Waste Toner  
indicator on the control panel.  
When the waste toner box is not set, the light-blocking plate blocks the light between the  
photosensors, causing the copier to flash the Waste Toner indicator.  
HVT  
+5V  
Power  
supply  
PCB  
DC controller  
PCB  
J303  
-1  
J301  
J210  
-1 -10  
J106  
-9  
J212  
-16  
-2  
Comparator  
circuit  
-3  
Reference  
voltage  
circuit  
Light-blocking plate  
Stopper  
Waste toner sensor  
(light-receiving unit)  
Waste toner box  
Waste toner sensor  
(light-emitting unit)  
Figure 4-206  
4–18  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
When as many as 100 copies (A4) have been made during a pre-waste toner full condition,  
the DC controller PCB will identify the condition as “waste toner full,” stopping to flash the  
Waste Toner indicator and instead keeping it on. The copier will not accept the Start key while  
the Waste Toner indicator remains on.  
Reference:  
If the DC controller PCB identifies a waste toner full condition during continuous copying,  
the copier will discharge copies being processed and turn on the Waste Toner indicator.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
E. Control by the Cleaner Thermistor  
The copier is equipped with a thermistor (cleaner thermistor TH3) used to detect overheating  
of the drum cleaner assembly, and is designed to perform the following according to the  
temperature detected by the thermistor.  
• controlling the rotation of the exhaust fan (See p. 7-2.)  
• controlling the copying speed down sequence  
The cleaner thermistor checks for overheating of the drum cleaner at all times, and will  
indicate error code ‘E821’ on the control panel when it identifies a temperature of 55°C or more.  
1. Copying Speed Down Sequence  
The copier’s normal copying speed is 16 cpm (A4, Direct, non-AE).  
To prevent overheating of the drum cleaner assembly in continuous copying mode or  
overheating of the copyboard glass in enlargement mode, the copier adjusts the sheet-to-sheet  
distance according to the selected copy count and the reading of the cleaner thermistor (TH3).  
• A4 Original, A4 Copy  
Reading by cleaner  
thermistor (TH3)  
Copy count at lower than 500  
50 to100% 101 to141% 142 to200% 50 to100% 101 to141% 142 to200%  
Copy count at 500 or more  
Less than 40°C  
40°C or more  
16cpm  
16cpm  
12cpm  
12cpm  
12cpm  
8cpm  
12cpm  
12cpm  
12cpm  
12cpm  
12cpm  
8cpm  
Table 4-202  
4–20  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
F. Auto Density Adjustment (AE)  
1. Outline  
The copier is equipped with an automatic density adjustment mechanism (AE), which  
controls the developing DC bias to suit the density of originals. As long as the original is of even  
density, the AE mechanism is capable of ensuring copies free of fogging by changing the  
developing DC bias to suit the density of the original.  
2. Measuring the Density of the Original  
In initial rotation state (INTR), the scanning lamp (LA1) is turned on at a specific intensity  
and the scanner is moved forward 70 mm to expose the original. When the scanner has stopped,  
the light reflected by the area shown in Figure 4-208 (in reference to the original butting  
position) is measured by the AE sensor (photodiode), whose output is sent to the DC controller  
PCB as the AE sensor output signal (AE_DATA).  
Based on the signal, the DC controller PCB computes the optimum level of the developing  
DC bias for copying, and sends the result to the high-voltage power supply PCB as the  
developing bias control signal (DV_DC_CNT).  
Area of AE detection  
28 mm (approx.)  
56 mm (approx.)  
Center of image  
20 mm  
(approx.)  
70 mm  
(distance of scanner travel)  
Figure 4-208  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
Figure 4-209 shows changes in the developing DC bias in relation to the density of different  
originals. If the density of the original is higher (darker) than the Test Sheet and lower (lighter)  
than a newspaper, the developing DC bias will vary between F5.0 and F7.5 in terms of Copy  
Density lever position.  
If the original is lighter than the Test Sheet, copies are made at an F5.0 equivalent (-270 V);  
if it is darker than a newspaper, on the other hand, copies are made at an F7.5 equivalent (-400  
V).  
Developing bias DC (V)  
F7.5 equivalent  
F5.0 equivalent  
Density of original  
Lighter  
Test Sheet  
Darker  
Newspaper  
Figure 4-209  
F7.5  
F5.0  
Figure 4-210  
4–22  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
III. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY  
The copier may be disassembled and assembled as shown here. Pay attention to the copier's  
mechanical characteristics along with the steps for disassembly/assembly.  
Important:  
1. Turn off the power and disconnect the power plug to ensure safety whenever disassembling/  
assembling the copier.  
2. Unless otherwise noted, assemble the parts by reversing the steps used to disassemble them.  
3. Identify the screws by type (length, diameter) to avoid use in the wrong location.  
4. Use a washer where needed. The mounting screws used for the grounding wire and varistor  
come with a washer to ensure electric continuity. Do not forget to use these washers.  
5. As a rule, do not operate the copier with any of its parts removed.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
A. Scanning Lamp Assembly  
1. Removing the Scanning Lamp  
1) Remove the copyboard glass. (See .7-14)  
2) Holding the bend [A], pull out the scanner  
as far as the cut-off [B].  
[B]  
[A]  
[B]  
Figure 4-301  
3) Remove the mounting screw [1], and  
remove the reflecting cover [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 4-302  
4–24  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
4) Wrap both ends of the scanning lamp [3]  
with lint-free paper. Then, remove the  
lamp while pushing toward the rear end.  
Caution:  
1. Do not work if the surface of the  
scanning lamp is hot.  
2. Do not leave fingerprints on the  
surface of the scanning lamp.  
3. If the surface of the scanning lamp  
is soiled, dry wipe it.  
[3]  
Figure 4-303  
4. Do not leave fingerprints on the  
reflecting cover.  
5. Do not deform the reflecting cover.  
2. Mounting the Scanning Lamp  
Mount the scanning lamp by reversing the  
steps used to remove it. However, keep the  
following in mind:  
• Orient the scanning lamp so that the  
side with the shorter boss-to-terminal  
length is toward the rear.  
45˚  
• Orient the scanning lamp so that the  
boss is at the angle indicated in Figure  
4-304.  
Figure 4-304  
[1]  
3. Removing the Thermal Fuse  
1) Remove the scanning lamp.  
2) Remove the two mounting screws[1], and  
remove the thermal fuse [2].  
Caution:  
Mount the thermal fuse by reversing  
the steps used to remove it. Be careful  
of the orientation of the fuse.  
[2]  
Figure 4-305  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
B. Exposure Assembly  
1. Removing the Pre-Exposure/Blank  
Exposure Lamp Assembly  
1) Remove the developing assembly. (See  
p.4-37)  
[3]  
[2]  
2) Remove the drum unit. (See p.4-28)  
3) Remove the inside over.  
4) Disconnect the two connectors [1], and  
remove the mounting screw [2] ; then,  
remove the pre-exposure/blank exposure  
lamp assembly [3].  
[1]  
Figure 4-306  
2. Removing the Dust-Proofing Glass  
1) Remove the inside cover.  
2) Remove the mounting screws [1], and  
remove the dust-proofing glass [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 4-307  
4–26  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
3. Cleaning the No. 6 Mirror  
1) Remove the developing assembly. (See p.  
4-37.)  
2) Remove the drum unit. (See p. 4-28.)  
3) Remove the dust-proofing glass. (See p.  
4-26.)  
4) Remove the mounting screw [1], and  
remove the developing assembly rail [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 4-308  
5) Clean the No. 6 mirror [3].  
[3]  
Figure 4-309  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
C. Drum Unit  
1. Removing the Drum Unit  
1) Open the top unit, release the developing  
assembly.  
[1]  
[2]  
2) Remove the thumb screw [1], and slide  
out the drum unit [2] to the front to remove.  
Caution:  
• The photosensitive drum is  
susceptible to strong light. If it was  
subjected to strong light for a long  
time, it can cause copies to have  
white spots or black lines.  
Whenever you have taken out the  
drum unit from the copier, be sure to  
keep it in the bag used at time of  
installation. If the bag is not at hand,  
substitute several sheets of fresh  
copy paper to wrap the drum unit,  
and keep it in a dark place.  
Figure 4-310  
• When mounting the drum unit to the  
copier, be sure to slide it along the  
rails and work with extra care.  
4–28  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
2. Cleaning the Photosensitive Drum  
If the surface of the photosensitive drum  
is soiled, wipe it with a flannel cloth coated  
with toner.  
Caution:  
• Do not dry wipe the surface of the  
photosensitive drum. Do not use  
solvent.  
• Do not use paper, lint-free or  
otherwise, to avoid damaging the  
surface of the photosensitive drum.  
• Work briskly when cleaning the  
photosensitive drum to avoid  
unnecessarily subjecting it to light  
and thus affecting images.  
• If you must rotate the photosensitive  
drum, be sure to rotate it in the same  
direction as it would when making  
copies.  
[1]  
[3]  
[2]  
3. Removing the Cleaner Thermistor  
1) Remove the drum unit. (See p. 4-28.)  
2) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
3) Disconnect the connector [1], and remove  
the mounting screw [2]; then, remove the  
cleaner thermistor [3].  
Figure 4-311  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
D. Primary Charging  
Assembly  
1. Removing the Primary Charging  
Assembly  
[3]  
1) Remove the drum unit. (See p. 4-28.)  
2) Pull the charging wire cleaning lever [1]  
slightly to the front.  
[2]  
3) Detach the hook [2], and detach the drum  
front cover [3].  
[1]  
Figure 4-312  
4) Remove the mounting screw [4], and  
remove the primary charging assembly  
[5].  
[5]  
[4]  
Figure 4-313  
4–30  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
E. Transfer Charging  
Assembly  
1. Removing the Transfer Charging  
Assembly  
[4]  
1) Open the copier top, and remove the front  
door.  
2) Pull the charging wire cleaning lever [1]  
slightly to the front.  
3) Remove the mounting screw [2], and lift  
the stopper [3] to remove.  
4) Pull the transfer charging assembly [4] to  
the front to remove.  
[1]  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 4-314  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
F. Charging Wire  
1. Outline  
As many as two charging wires are  
located around the photosensitive drum.  
(These charging wires are 0.06 mm in  
diameter.)  
2. Stringing the Charging Wires  
Basically, all charging wires are strung in  
the same way. (The following uses the  
primary charging wire as an example.)  
1) Remove the mounting screw [1], and  
remove the stopper [2] and the grid plate  
[3].  
To remove the transfer charging  
assembly, remove the three hooks [a], and  
remove the guide wire plate [b].  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
[1]  
[a]  
[a]  
[a]  
[3]  
[2]  
[b]  
Figure 4-315b  
Figure 4-315a  
4–32  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
2) Remove the sheet (front) [4] and the sheet  
(rear) [5].  
To remove the transfer charging  
assembly, remove the sheet (front) [c] and  
the sheet (rear) [d].  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
[c]  
[d]  
[5]  
[4]  
Figure 4-316a  
Figure 4-316b  
3) Remove the spring [6], and remove the  
charging wire [7].  
To remove the transfer charging  
assembly, remove the spring [e], and  
remove the charging wire [f].  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
[e]  
[7]  
[6]  
[f]  
Figure 4-317b  
Figure 4-317a  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
4) Free a length of about 5 cm from the  
charging wire reel (0.06 mm wire).  
Reference:  
To form a loop, wind the charging wire  
around a hex key once, and turn the hex  
key three to four times; then, twist the  
charging wire.  
5) Cut the end (excess) of the twisted  
charging wire with a nipper.  
6) Hook the loop on the charging electrode  
at the rear.  
Figure 4-318  
7) Hook the charging wire on the charging  
wire positioner at the rear, and hook the  
charging wire tension spring on the  
charging wire by the distance A; then,  
twist it.  
A
A:  
Figure 4-319  
Primary charging assembly : 13.0 ±0.5 mm  
Transfer charging assembly : 12.0 ±0.5 mm  
4–34  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
8) Cut the excess charging wire with a  
nipper.  
9) Pick the end of the charging wire  
tensioning spring with tweezers, and hook  
it on the charging electrode.  
Figure 4-320  
Note:  
Go through the following:  
• Be sure that the charging wire is free  
of bending and twisting, and its gold  
plating has not peeled.  
• Be sure that the charging wire is in  
the V-groove of the charging wire  
positioner.  
(correct)  
(wrong)  
Figure 4-321  
10) Wipe the charging wire with lint-free  
paper moistened with alcohol.  
Caution:  
• Do not use a cloth carrying metal  
powder for cleaning.  
• Do not use a moist cloth for  
cleaning.  
• Dry wipe with lint-free paper; then,  
mount only after making sure that  
alcohol has completely evaporated.  
11) Mount the sheet (front) and the sheet  
(rear).  
12) Mount the stopper and the grid plate.  
For the transfer charging assembly, mount  
the guide wire plate.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
3. Adjusting the Height of the  
Charging Wires  
Charging  
assembly  
Height of charging  
wire (mm)  
Range  
1.0mm  
To adjust each charging wire, turn its  
respective height adjusting screw. A full turn  
on the screw will change the height of the  
primary charging wire by about 0.5 mm and  
that of the transfer charging wire by about 0.7  
mm.  
11.0 0.2mm  
Primary  
Transfer  
1.0mm  
9.5 0.2mm  
Figure 4-322  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Figure 4-323b  
Figure 4-323a  
4–36  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
G. Developing Assembly  
[2] [1]  
[3]  
1. Removing the Developing  
Assembly  
1) Open the front door, and release the  
developing assembly.  
2) Remove the mounting screw [1], and  
remove the stopper [2].  
3) Pull the developing assembly [3] to  
remove.  
Figure 4-324  
Caution:  
Take care not to damage the  
developing cylinder.  
2. Removing the Developing Blade  
1) Remove the developing assembly.  
2) Remove the mounting screw [1] and the  
three hooks [2]; then, remove the  
developing front cover [3].  
[1]  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 4-325  
[4]  
3) Remove the three mounting screws [4],  
and detach the developing blade cover [5].  
[5]  
Figure 4-326  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
4) Lift the front of the developing upper  
cover [6] slightly, and slide it in the  
direction of the arrow to remove.  
[6]  
Figure 4-327  
5) Place a newspaper or the like on the floor,  
and empty the developing assembly of  
toner.  
6) Put copy paper between the developing  
blade and the developing cylinder.  
7) Remove the two mounting screws [7], and  
remove the developing blade [8].  
[8]  
Caution:  
When mounting the developing blade,  
be sure to put copy paper on the  
developing cylinder before mounting  
the developing blade so as to protect  
the cylinder.  
[7]  
Figure 4-328  
3. Removing the Developing Cylinder  
1) Remove the developing blade. (See p. 4-  
37.)  
2) Remove the mounting screw [1], and  
remove the magnet positioning plate [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 4-329  
4–38  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
3) Remove the grip ring [3], and remove the  
developing roll [4].  
4) Remove the two mounting screws [5], and  
remove the bearing holder (front) [6] and  
the bearing [7].  
[5]  
[7]  
[6]  
[5]  
[4]  
[3]  
Figure 4-330  
5) Remove the two mounting screws [8], and  
remove the gear support plate [9].  
Caution:  
Take extra care when removing the  
gear support plate. The gear will be  
freed.  
[8]  
[9]  
Figure 4-331  
6) Remove the E-ring [10], and remove the  
gear [11].  
7) Remove the grip ring [12], and remove  
the gear [13].  
[11]  
[10]  
8) Remove the gear [14].  
[14]  
[12]  
[13]  
Figure 4-332  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
4–39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 4 IMAGE FORMATION SYSTEM  
9) Remove the two mounting screws [15];  
then, remove the bearing holder (rear)  
[16], bearing [17], and developing roll  
[18].  
[16]  
[15]  
[18]  
[17]  
Figure 4-333  
10) Remove the developing cylinder [19].  
Caution  
Do not leave fingerprints or oils on  
the surface of the developing cylinder.  
As necessary, dry wipe the surface  
with lint-free paper.  
[19]  
Figure 4-334  
4–40  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5  
PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
This chapter explains the principles used from when copy paper is picked up to when a copy is delivered  
in view of the functions of electrical and mechanical units and in relation to their timing of operation. It  
also shows how these units may be disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION ..................... 5-1  
II. PICK-UP FROM THE CASSETTE .......... 5-2  
A. Pick-Up Operation .............................. 5-2  
B. Sequence of Operations  
(pick-up/feeding) ................................ 5-3  
C. Operation of the Cassette Lifter ......... 5-4  
D. Detecting the Size of the Cassette .... 5-6  
III. PICK-UP FROM THE MULTIFEEDER .... 5-8  
A. Pick-Up Operation .............................. 5-8  
B. Detecting the Size of Paper  
IV. CONTROLLING THE REGISTRATION  
CLUTCH ................................................. 5-11  
V. DETECTING JAMS ................................ 5-12  
A. Outline .............................................. 5-12  
B. Sequence of Operations  
(jam detection).................................. 5-13  
VI. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................. 5-15  
A. Pick-Up Assembly ............................ 5-16  
B. Multifeeder Assembly....................... 5-20  
C. Registration Roller Assembly........... 5-23  
D. Cassette Assembly .......................... 5-24  
in the Multifeeder................................ 5-9  
C. Sequence of Operations  
(pick-up from multifeeder) ................ 5-10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION  
The copier uses a center reference feeding method, in which copy paper is moved along the  
center of the pick-up/feeding path to ensure stable movement.  
The pick-up system consists of the cassette No. 1 holder and the multifeeder. Copy paper  
picked up from the cassette or the multifeeder is controlled by the registration roller so that it is  
aligned with the leading edge of the image on the photosensitive drum, and is sent through the  
transfer, separation, and fixing assemblies and then to the copy tray.  
As many as two sensors are used to monitor the movement of the copy paper.  
No.  
PS5  
PS6  
Sensor  
Description  
Registration paper sensor  
Delivery paper sensor  
Detects delay/stationary jams, measures paper length.  
Detects delay/stationary jams.  
Table 5-101  
Registration  
roller  
Fixing  
assembly  
Photosensitive  
drum  
Multifeeder  
PS6  
PS5  
Cassette  
Figure 5-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
II. PICK-UP FROM THE CASSETTE  
A. Pick-Up Operation  
The pick-up roller and the feed roller are controlled by the pick-up solenoid (SL1).  
The stack of copy paper inside the cassette is held up by the lifter, and the pick-up roller is  
controlled by the pick-up solenoid and is kept away from the surface of the stack.  
When the pick-up solenoid turns on, the claws move away from the pick-up gear, and the  
drive of the main motor (M1) is transmitted to the pick-up roller and the feed roller.  
A single sheet of copy paper is picked up and sent to the feed roller by the work of the pick-  
up roller and the separation claws. If multiple sheets should be picked up, the feed roller and the  
separation roller would serve to make sure that no more than a single sheet is sent forward to the  
vertical path roller.  
The copy paper is then moved by the vertical path roller to the registration roller. In response,  
the registration roller controls the movement of the copy paper so that its leading edge matches  
the image on the photosensitive drum.  
Power supply  
Feed roller  
Registration roller  
PCB  
Main motor drive  
command  
Vertical  
path roller  
Pick-up  
roller  
M1  
Registration paper detection signal (RGPDT)  
CL2  
Photosensitive  
_
Feed roller clutch drive command (FEED CL*)  
drum  
DC  
controller  
PCB  
Registration roller  
Power supply  
clutch drive  
PCB  
command  
CL1  
SL1  
PS5  
_
(RG CL*)  
_
Pick-up solenoid drive command (PU SL*)  
Cassette paper detection signal (CSTPDT)  
PS4  
Separation roller  
Figure 5-201  
5–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
B. Sequence of Operations (pick-up/feeding)  
A4, 2 Copies  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR STBY  
Main motor (M1)  
FW  
RV  
Scanner motor (M2)  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Pick-up solenoid (SL1)  
Registlation paper sensor  
(PS5)  
Registlation roller clutch  
(CL1)  
Feed roller clutch (CL2)  
Delivery paper sensor (PS6)  
Figure 5-202  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
C. Operation of the Cassette Lifter  
When the cassette is pushed inside the copier, the lifter stopper will be freed, and the lifter  
will move up by the force of a spring. At this time, the copy paper will push up the paper  
detecting lever of the cassette paper sensor (PS4) to enable detection of the presence/absence of  
copy paper.  
The rear end guide plate is slid in conjunction with the upward movement of the lifter to  
improve pick-up performance.  
Paper detection lever  
Lifter stopper  
PS4  
Lifter  
Rear guide plate  
Figure 5-205  
5–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
The copier’s cassette is designed to apply auxiliary pressure on paper of B4 or wider. The  
auxiliary tension spring acts on the lifter through the cut-off in the bottom of the cassette when  
the side guide plate is slid to the outside. In the case of paper narrower than B4, the spring  
remains slack and therefore does not act on the lifter.  
Auxiliary pressure spring  
Cut-off  
Auxiliary pressure lever  
Lifter  
Figure 5-206  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
D. Detecting the Size of the Cassette  
1. Outline  
The presence of paper and the size of paper inside the cassette are checked by the cassette  
size switch PCB mounted to the left of the cassette slot.  
When the cassette is set in the copier, the cassette paper size switching block and the AB/  
Inch switching block act on the cassette size switch PCB to enable detection of the presence/  
absence of a cassette and the size of paper inside it.  
The cassette paper size switching block slid to the front and rear by the work of the cam  
linked to the cassette paper size dial, causing the cassette paper size switching block to turn on/  
off the cassette size switch PCB.  
The AB/Inch switching block, on the other hand, turns on/off the switch on the cassette size  
switch PCB according to how it is positioned. (The AB and Inch size notations are switched over  
by sliding the AB/Inch switching lever.)  
AB/Inch  
changing lever  
Cassette paper  
size display  
Cassette paper size  
changing block  
U1  
A4R  
Cassette paper size  
setting knob  
Cam  
AB/Inch changing block  
Figure 5-207  
5–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
2. Detecting the Cassette Size  
The AB configuration and the Inch configuration are distinguished by the switch (SW654) on  
the cassette switching PCB.  
The size of the paper inside the cassette is identified with reference to the states (on/off) of  
the switches (SW651 through 653) on the cassette size switch PCB.  
Table 5-201 shows the combinations used to identify specific paper sizes.  
Cassette size switch PCB  
SW651  
SW652  
SW653  
SW654  
Figure 5-208  
•AB size (SW654=0)  
•Inch size (SW654=1)  
Result of detection  
SW651 SW652 SW653  
Result of detection  
No cassette  
LGL  
SW651 SW652 SW653  
No cassette  
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
B5  
A4  
U2*  
A3  
LDR  
B5R  
LTR  
B4  
LTR-R  
A4R  
U1*  
No cassette  
No cassette  
*Non-AB/Inch configuration sizes may be registered  
(default sizes only) in service mode [5].  
Table 5-201  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
III. PICK-UP FROM THE MULTIFEEDER  
A. Pick-Up Operation  
The presence/absence of copy paper in the multifeeder is detected by the multifeeder paper  
sensor (PS7).  
When the multifeeder is selected and the Start key is pressed, the multifeeder solenoid (SL2)  
turns on to butt the paper guide plate against the multifeeder pick-up roller.  
Then, the multifeeder roller clutch (CL3) turns on to transmit the drive of the main motor  
(M1) to the multifeeder pick-up roller. A single sheet of copy paper is picked up from the stack  
by the work of the multifeeder pick-up roller and the separation pad, and is sent to the  
registration roller.  
This sequence of operations is repeated for each pick-up operation.  
DC controller PCB  
Stopper  
CL3  
SL2  
Multifeed  
roller  
clutch (CL3)  
Multifeed  
solenoid  
(SL2)  
Control ring  
Cam  
M1  
Paper guide  
plate  
Control ring  
Cam  
Multifeeder paper  
sensor (PS7)  
Multifeed roller  
Separation pad  
Paper guide plate  
Figure 5-301  
5–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
B. Detecting the Size of Paper in the Multifeeder  
When the user sets the slide guide of the multifeeder to the width of copy paper, the  
multifeeder paper width sensor 1 (PS9) and the multifeeder paper width sensor (PS10) operating  
in conjunction with the movement of the side guide detect the width of the copy paper.  
The identified width is used for blank exposure and fixing temperature control. The length of  
copy paper in multifeeder mode is detected with reference to how long the registration paper  
sensor (PS5) remains on.  
Slide guide (front)  
PS10  
PS9  
Tape  
Slide guide (rear)  
Multifeeder paper width  
detection signal 1 (MLTPD1)  
DC  
controller  
PCB  
PS9  
Multifeeder paper width  
detection signal 2 (MLTPD2)  
PS10  
Slide guide (front)  
Multifeeder tray  
Figure 5-302  
Paper width (mm)  
Paper width > 257  
PS9  
0
PS10  
1
1
0
0
>
257 Paper width > 216  
1
=
>
216 Paper width > 182  
1
=
>
182 Paper width  
0
=
Table 5-301  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
C. Sequence of Operations (pick-up from multifeeder)  
A4, 2 Copies  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
AER  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR STBY  
Main motor (M1)  
FW  
RV  
Scanner motor (M2)  
Scanner home position  
sensor (PS1)  
Multifeed solenoid (SL2)  
Registration paper sensor  
(PS5)  
Registration roller clutch  
(CL1)  
Multifeed roller clutch (CL3)  
Delivery paper sensor (PS6)  
Figure 5-303  
5–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
IV. CONTROLLING THE REGISTRATION CLUTCH  
The registration clutch exerts the following control so as to match copy paper with the image  
on the photosensitive drum at a specific location.  
Selected copy mode  
Control timing  
A
Image area on copy paper  
Remarks  
Standard copying  
Page separation  
A
A
B
The size of margin  
C varies to suit the  
C
Centering  
OFF  
selected reproduction  
ratio and copy paper  
size. The size of margin  
D is 21.6 mm maximum.  
Fit to page  
D
C-D  
Centering  
ON  
Copy paper  
Image area  
Drum  
Drum  
Image on drum  
Copy paper  
Image on drum  
Copy paper  
B
A
Copy paper behind image  
on drum  
Copy paper ahead of  
image on drum  
Figure 5-401  
If centering is turned on in Fit Page mode, control is exerted so that half of the trailing edge  
C resulting in relation to the selected reproduction ratio and copy paper size will be the leading  
edge margin. The maximum leading edge margin in such cases, however, is 21.6 mm.  
If centering is turned off in Fit Page mode, control is exerted so that the leading edge of copy  
paper and the leading edge of the image on the photosensitive drum match.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
V. DETECTING JAMS  
A. Outline  
The copier is equipped with the following two sensors used to check the movement of copy  
paper.  
• Registration paper sensor (PS5)  
• Delivery paper sensor (PS6)  
Jams are identified in relation to the presence/absence of copy paper over each sensor at such  
times as programmed in the microprocessor. As soon as a jam is identified, the microprocessor  
will immediately stop the operation, and flash the Jam indicator on the control panel.  
The microprocessor identifies any of the following conditions as a jam:  
a. Paper exists over a specific sensor at power-on, at end of warm-up, or during standby  
(power-on jam).  
b. Paper fails to reach a specific sensor within a specific period of time (delay jam).  
1. Registration delay jam detected by the registration paper sensor (PS5).  
2. Delivery delay jam detected by the delivery paper sensor (PS6).  
c. Paper does not move past a specific sensor within a specific period of time (stationary jam).  
1. Registration stationary jam detected by the registration paper sensor (PS5).  
2. Delivery paper stationary jam detected by the delivery paper sensor (PS6).  
Registration  
roller  
Multifeed  
roller  
Fixing  
assembly  
Multifeeder  
Photo-  
sensitive  
drum  
Vertical path  
roller  
PS6  
PS5  
Cassette  
Pick-up  
roller  
Feed Separation  
roller roller  
Figure 5-501  
5–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
B. Sequence of Operations (jam detection)  
1. Registration Delay Jam  
Start key  
ON  
Jam indicator  
flashed  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
SCFW SCRV SCFW  
approx  
1.5sec  
approx  
1.5sec  
Jam check  
Pick-up solenoid (SL1)  
Feed roller clutch (CL2)  
Registration paper sensor  
(PS5)  
Normal  
Error  
Main motor (M1)  
Figure 5-502  
2. Registration Stationary Jam  
Start key  
ON  
Jam indicator  
flashed  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
SCFW SCRV SCFW  
*1  
*1  
Jam check  
Pick-up solenoid (SL1)  
Feed roller clutch (CL2)  
Registration paper sensor  
(PS5)  
Normal  
Error  
Main motor (M1)  
*1:Varies according to paper size.  
Figure 5-503  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
3. Delivery Delay Jam  
Start key  
ON  
Jam indicator  
flashed  
Sequence  
Jam check  
STBY  
INTR  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV  
approx 2.2sec  
approx 2.2sec  
Registration roller clutch  
(CL1)  
Normal  
Error  
Delivery paper sensor (PS6)  
Main motor (M1)  
Figure 5-504  
4. Delivery Stationary Jam  
Start key  
ON  
Jam indicator  
flashed  
Sequence  
Jam check  
STBY  
INTR  
SCFW SCRV SCFW SCRV LSTR  
*1  
*1  
Registration roller clutch  
(CL1)  
Normal  
Error  
Delivery paper sensor (PS6)  
Main motor (M1)  
*1:Varies according to paper size.  
Figure 5-505  
5–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
VI. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY  
The copier may be disassembled and assembled as shown here. Pay attention to the copier’s  
mechanical characteristics along with the steps for disassembly/assembly.  
Important:  
1. Turn off the power and disconnect the power plug to ensure safety whenever disassembling/  
assembling the copier.  
2. Unless otherwise noted, assemble the parts by reversing the steps used to disassemble them.  
3. Identify the screws by type (length, diameter) to avoid use in the wrong location.  
4. Use a washer where needed. The mounting screws used for the grounding wire and varistor  
come with a washer to ensure electric continuity. Do not forget to use these washers.  
5. As a rule, do not operate the copier with any of its parts removed.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
A. Pick-Up Assembly  
1. Removing the Pick-Up Roller  
1) Remove the cassette.  
[3]  
[2]  
[1]  
2) Remove the stepped screw [1], and pull  
the roller support plate [2] to the front to  
remove.  
3) Remove the pick-up roller assembly [3].  
Figure 5-601  
4) Push the section indicated by an arrow,  
and remove the two pick-up rollers [4].  
[4]  
Figure 5-602  
2. Mounting the Pick-Up Roller  
Mount the pick-up roller by reversing the  
steps used to remove it and with the following  
in mind:  
• Match the boss on the pick-up roller and the  
cut-off in the holder.  
• Do not detach the rubber section of the  
pick-up roller.  
• When mounting the pick-up roller assembly  
to the copier, be sure to position it securely  
face up.  
5–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
3. Removing the Pick-Up Drive  
Assembly  
[1]  
1) Remove the registration roller assembly.  
(See p. 5-23.)  
2) Remove the E-ring [1], and slide the  
vertical path roll [2] in the direction of the  
arrow.  
3) Remove the bushing [3], and then vertical  
path roller [2] together with the gear [4].  
[3]  
[2]  
[2]  
[4]  
Figure 5-603  
[5]  
4) Remove the four mounting screws [5],  
and remove the pick-up drive assembly  
[6].  
[6]  
[5]  
Figure 5-604  
4. Removing the Pick-Up Assembly  
1) Remove the separation roller assembly.  
(See p. 5-18.)  
2) Remove the registration roller assembly.  
(See p. 5-23.)  
[2]  
3) Disconnect the connector [1], and remove  
the two screws [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 5-605  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
4) Slide the pick-up assembly [3] to the rear,  
and remove the hook.  
[3]  
Figure 5-606  
5. Removing the Feed Roller  
1) Remove the separation roller assembly.  
2) While holding the claw [A], move the  
feed roller [2] in the direction of the arrow  
to remove.  
[A]  
[2]  
Figure 5-607  
6. Removing the Separation Roller  
1) Remove the cassette.  
2) Remove the right door. (See p.7-10)  
3) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
remove the separation roller assembly [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 5-608  
5–18  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
4) Remove the roller cover [3].  
[3]  
Figure 5-609  
[5]  
5) Remove the two bushings [4], and remove  
the two springs [5].  
[4]  
Figure 5-610  
[6]  
6) While pushing the claw [A] with a flat-  
blade screwdriver, remove the separation  
roller [6].  
[A]  
Figure 5-611  
7. Mounting the Separation Roller  
Mount the separation roller by reversing  
the steps used to remove it and with the  
following in mind:  
[1]  
[2]  
• When mounting the separation roller, be  
sure to fit the pin [1] in the groove [2]  
of the holder.  
• When mounting the roller cover, be sure  
so that the roller cover will push against  
the bushing.  
Figure 5-612  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
B. Multifeeder Assembly  
1. Removing the Multifeeder Tray  
1) Open the multifeeder tray, and remove the  
face cover [1] using a flat-blade  
screwdriver.  
[1]  
Figure 5-613  
2) Remove the guide pin [2], and remove the  
multifeeder tray [3].  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 5-614  
2. Removing the Multifeeder  
Assembly  
1) Remove the rear cover, and open the right  
door.  
[1]  
2) Remove the lower inside cover. (See p.7-  
12.)  
3) Disconnect the two connectors [1], and  
remove the mounting screw [2].  
[2]  
Figure 5-615  
5–20  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
4) Disconnect the two connectors [3], and  
remove the three mounting screws [4];  
then, detach the multifeeder assembly [5].  
[3]  
The two holes each  
(upper/lower) are  
spare holes.  
[5]  
[4]  
[4]  
Figure 5-616  
3. Removing the Multifeeder Pick-Up  
Roller  
1) Remove the developing assembly. (See p.  
4-37.)  
[1]  
2) Remove the drum unit. (See p. 4-28.)  
3) Remove the E-ring [1]; then, while  
pushing down the multifeeder separation  
pad [2] to free it from pressure, detach the  
multifeeder pick-up roller [3].  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 5-617  
4. Removing the Separation Pad  
1) Execute service mode 402 (multifeeder  
holding plate release) in standby state so  
as to lift the multifeeder holding plate [1].  
[1]  
Figure 5-618  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
2) Turn off the copier, and disconnect the  
power plug.  
Caution:  
Whenever you need to perform  
disassembly/assembly work, be sure  
to turn off the copier and disconnect  
its power plug.  
[2]  
[3]  
3) Open the right door.  
4) Remove the mounting screw [2], and slide  
the multifeeder separation pad assembly  
[3] in the direction of the arrow to  
remove.  
Figure 5-619  
[4]  
[5]  
5) Detach the multifeeder separation pad [5]  
from the holder [4].  
Figure 5-620  
5. Adjusting the Pressure of the  
Separation Pad  
If double feeding or pick-up failure  
occurs, loosen the adjusting screw [1] and  
relocate the holder [2] to adjust the force of  
the separation pad tension spring.  
• If pick-up failure occurs, move the holder in  
the direction of [A].  
[2]  
[A]  
[B]  
• If double feeding occurs, move the holder  
in the direction of [B].  
[1]  
Figure 5-621  
5–22  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
C. Registration Roller  
Assembly  
[1]  
1. Removing the Registration Roller  
Assembly  
1) Remove the developing assembly. (See p.  
4-37.)  
2) Remove the drum unit. (See p. 4-28.)  
3) Remove the multifeeder assembly. (See p.  
5-20.)  
4) Disconnect the connector [1], and remove  
the grip right [2]; then, detach the  
registration roller clutch [3].  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 5-622  
[5]  
5) Disconnect the connector [4], and remove  
the three mounting screws [5]; then,  
detach the registration roller assembly [6].  
[5]  
[6]  
[4]  
Figure 5-623  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
D. Cassette Assembly  
1. Removing the Cassette Size Switch  
1) Remove the cassette.  
2) Remove the delivery lower cover. (See  
p.7-11)  
3) Disconnect the connector [1] (J110) of the  
DC controller PCB, and remove the  
mounting screw [2] ; then, free the  
harness from the harness guide.  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 5-624  
[5]  
[4]  
[3]  
4) Remove the mounting screw [3], and  
remove the stopper [4].  
5) Remove the cassette switch assembly [5].  
Figure 5-625  
[7]  
[8]  
[6]  
6) Remove the hook [6], and remove the  
cassette size switch [7].  
Caution:  
When mounting the cassette size  
switch assembly, check to make sure  
that the cassette size switch assembly  
slides normally by the work of the  
spring [8] pressure.  
Figure 5-626  
5–24  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
2. Changing the Cassette Size (AB/  
INCH)  
•AB  
1) Slide out the cassette.  
[2] [1]  
2) Loosen the mounting screw [1] on the left  
side of the cassette; then, slide the size  
switching block [2] to the desired size  
position, and fix it in place.  
[1]  
[2]  
•INCH  
•AB  
Figure 5-627  
3) Remove the mounting screw [3]; then,  
slide the size switching lever [4] to the  
desired size position, and fix it in place.  
[4]  
[3]  
[4]  
[3]  
•INCH  
Figure 5-628  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
5–25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 5 PICK-UP/FEEDING SYSTEM  
3. Adjusting the Left/Right  
Registration  
Turn the adjusting screw [1] until the  
cassette locking lever plate [2] and the  
cassette locking lever [3] engage.  
When the adjusting screw [1] is turned  
clockwise, the cassette locking plate moves to  
the front.  
[1]  
When the adjusting screw [1] is turned  
counterclockwise, the cassette locking lever  
plate [2] moves to the rear.  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 5-629  
(-)  
(+)  
0
2
4
6
8
10  
Figure 5-630  
5–26  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6  
FIXING SYSTEM  
This chapter explains the principles used to fuse toner images to transfer medium in view of the func-  
tions of electrical and mechanical units and in relation to their timing of operation. It also shows how  
these units may be disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION ..................... 6-1  
A. Outline ................................................ 6-1  
B. Controlling the Fixing Temperature ... 6-2  
C. Error Detection Circuit........................ 6-5  
II. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................... 6-7  
A. Fixing Assembly ................................. 6-8  
B. Delivery Assembly............................ 6-16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
I. OUTLINE OF OPERATION  
A. Outline  
The upper roller and the lower roller of the fixing assembly and the delivery roller of the  
delivery assembly are operated by the drive from the main motor (M1) coming through gears.  
The upper roller has a built-in heater which is kept on during WMUP after power-on at 1000  
W (120 V)/1050 W (230 V). Other than WMUP, the heater is subjected to phase control, and is  
turned on at 805 w (120/230 V) or off.  
The fixing temperature is detected with reference to the surface temperature of the upper  
roller rear end detected by the main thermistor (TH1) and the sub thermistor (TH2), and is  
communicated to the microprocessor on the DC controller PCB.  
Based on the thermistor signal (TH1, TH2), the DC controller PCB turns on/off the fixing  
heater drive signal (HEAT_DR) to turn on/off the fixing heater (H1), thereby keeping it at the  
target temperature. To cut off AC power to the heater in the event of overheating, a thermal  
switch (TSW1) is mounted at the front of the fixing upper roller.  
The copier is designed to remove toner adhering to the upper or the lower roller; for this  
reason, its heat discharge roller is kept in firm contact with the lower roller.  
Fixing sub thermistor signal (TH2)  
+24V GND  
RL1  
_
HEAT DR  
Power  
supply  
PCB  
DC  
controller  
PCB  
TSW1  
H1  
_
HEAT ERR  
TH1  
TH2  
Fixing main thermistor signal (TH1)  
Fixing upper  
roller  
Delivery  
roller  
Pressure  
roller  
Heat discharge  
roller  
M1  
Figure 6-101  
Reference:  
Fixing heater:  
Thermal switch:  
1000 W for the 120 V model, 1050 W for the 230 V model.  
230 ±10°C.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
B. Controlling the Fixing Temperature  
The copier uses two thermistors mounted at the rear ends of the upper roller to monitor  
surface temperature. When copies are made continuously using sheets of B4 or less, the  
temperature of the area (center) coming into contact with the paper will be lower than the  
temperature of the areas (ends) not coming into contact with the paper. To prevent such a  
problem, the target temperature is varied in steps to suit the width of copy paper and the  
temperature detected by the thermistor during copying operation.  
To improve fixing on rough surface paper or tracing paper, a special paper mode (U13) has  
been added to user mode, thereby enabling a target temperature unique to these types of paper.  
• Paper Width >257 mm  
Target temperature immediately  
after Start key on  
Target temperature during  
continuous copying (upper limit)  
Temperature detected by  
thermistor at Start key on  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
Less than 170°C  
171°C  
181°C  
181°C  
181°C  
196°C  
200°C  
206°C  
209°C  
161°C  
171°C  
171°C  
171°C  
170°C or more, less than 180°C  
180°C or more, less than 190°C  
190°C or more  
181°C  
209°C  
171°C  
Table 6-101  
• 257 mm > Paper Width > 216 mm  
Target temperature immediately  
after Start key on  
Target temperature during  
continuous copying (upper limit)  
Temperature detected by  
thermistor at Start key on  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
169°C  
Less than 170°C  
179°C  
188°C  
193°C  
193°C  
196°C  
201°C  
206°C  
211°C  
170°C or more, less than 180°C  
180°C or more, less than 190°C  
190°C or more  
178°C  
193°C  
211°C  
183°C  
183°C  
183°C  
Table 6-102  
• 216 mm > Paper Width > 182 mm  
Target temperature immediately  
after Start key on  
Target temperature during  
continuous copying (upper limit)  
Temperature detected by  
thermistor at Start key on  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
167°C  
Less than 170°C  
177°C  
186°C  
192°C  
200°C  
196°C  
202°C  
207°C  
214°C  
170°C or more, less than 180°C  
180°C or more, less than 190°C  
190°C or more  
176°C  
200°C  
214°C  
190°C  
182°C  
190°C  
Table 6-103  
6–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
• 182 mm > Paper Width  
Target temperature immediately  
after Start key on  
Target temperature during  
continuous copying (upper limit)  
Temperature detected by  
thermistor at Start key on  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
General plain paper Paper with rough surface  
Tracing paper  
165°C  
Less than 170°C  
175°C  
186°C  
194°C  
200°C  
196°C  
204°C  
208°C  
215°C  
170°C or more, less than 180°C  
180°C or more, less than 190°C  
190°C or more  
176°C  
200°C  
215°C  
190°C  
184°C  
190°C  
Table 6-104  
• From Power-On to End of Copying  
Power switch  
ON  
Start key  
ON  
Sequence  
WMUP WMUPR STBY INTR  
COPY  
LSTR STBY  
(flashing) Green  
Orange  
Wait indicator  
Main motor (M1)  
Fixing heater (H1)  
Target temperature control  
220°C  
200°C  
180°C  
160°C  
140°C  
120°C  
*1  
Paper with rough surface mode  
General plain paper mode  
Tracing paper mode  
*1:Varies according to paper width.  
Figure 6-102  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
• Power Save Key ON or Auto-Power OFF  
Start key  
ON  
Energy saver Auto power  
key ON OFF  
Sequence  
STBY  
INTR  
COPY  
LSTR  
STBY  
*2  
Energy saver  
indicator  
Main motor (M1)  
Fixing heater (H1)  
Target temperature control  
220°C  
200°C  
180°C  
160°C  
140°C  
120°C  
*1  
*1:Varies according to paper width.  
*2:May be varied in user mode.  
Figure 6-103  
6–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
C. Error Detection Circuit  
1. Outline  
The copier’s error detection circuit is constructed as shown in Figure 6-104, and monitors the  
following items for an error:  
• Surface temperature of the upper fixing roller  
• Activation of the fixing heater (H1)  
AC power line  
DC signal line  
Fixing assembly  
CB1  
CB2  
TH1  
TH2  
LF  
J201  
-2  
H1  
TSW  
RL1  
DS1  
RL  
-1  
AC  
driver  
J210  
-1  
+24V  
-2  
Power supply PCB  
HVT  
+5V  
+5V  
Buffer  
+5V  
Buffer  
Error  
detection  
circuit  
+5V  
+
-
Gate  
array  
timer  
IC113  
Heater ON  
detection  
IC119  
CPU  
Converter  
-
+
DC controller PCB  
Figure 6-104  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
2. Surface Temperature of the Fixing Upper Roller  
The main thermistor (TH1) and the sub thermistor are arranged nearby at the rear of the  
fixing upper roller, and are used to monitor the difference in voltage between two thermistor  
signals (TH1, TH2).  
If either thermistor suffers an open circuit, the CW input terminal of the differential amplifier  
circuit will be about 5 V. At this time, the voltage of the other thermistor will decrease as the  
surface temperature of the fixing upper roller increases, gradually increasing the output of the  
differential amplifier circuit.  
When the output of the differential amplifier circuit exceeds the value set on the comparator,  
the comparator will send a signal to the gate array. When the gate array detects the signal from  
the comparator for a specific period of time, the DC controller PCB will cut off 24 V and AC  
power supply and, at the same time, will indicate ‘E000’, ‘E002’, or ‘E003’.  
If the connector of the main thermistor is not connected or both thermistors suffer an open  
circuit, the microprocessor will not be able to detect any excess increases in the surface  
temperature of the fixing upper roller, causing it to indicate ‘E000’, ‘E002’, or ‘E003’ on the  
control panel.  
3. Activation of the Fixing Heater (H1)  
The fixing heater error signal (HEAT_ERR) from the AC drier is monitored by IC113 on the  
DC controller PCB, and its reading is compared against the fixing heater drive signal  
(HEAT_DR) to find out whether the power to the fixing heater is normal or not.  
If the microprocessor on the DC controller PCB identifies the state of the fixing heater to be  
faulty, it will cut the power supplied to the fixing heater and, at the same time, will indicate  
‘E001’ on the control panel.  
6–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
II. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY  
The copier may be disassembled and assembled as shown here. Pay attention to the copier’s  
mechanical characteristics along with the steps for disassembly/assembly.  
Important:  
1. Turn off the power and disconnect the power plug to ensure safety whenever  
disassembling/assembling the copier.  
2. Unless otherwise noted, assemble the parts by reversing the steps used to disassemble  
them.  
3. Identify the screws by type (length, diameter) to avoid use in the wrong location.  
4. Use a washer where needed. The mounting screws used for the grounding wire and  
varistor come with a washer to ensure electric continuity. Do not forget to use these  
washers.  
5. As a rule, do not operate the copier with any of its parts removed.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
[1]  
A. Fixing Assembly  
1. Construction  
[1] Upper roller  
[2] Lower roller  
[3] Heat discharge roller  
[4] Delivery roller  
[4]  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 6-201  
2. Locking Mechanism  
Fulcrum  
Locking arm  
Figure 6-202  
[1]  
3. Removing the Fixing Assembly  
1) Remove the rear cover.  
2) Disconnect the connector [1].  
Figure 6-203  
6–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
3) Remove the drum unit. (See p. 4-28.)  
4) Remove the delivery upper cover. (See p.  
7-11.)  
5) Remove the delivery lower cover. (See p.  
7-11.)  
6) Disconnect the two connectors [2] (J108,  
J109) on the DC controller PCB, and free  
the wires from the harness guide.  
[2]  
Figure 6-204  
[4]  
7) Remove the front door.  
[6]  
[3]  
8) Turn the screw [3] counterclockwise, and  
remove the fixing knob [4].  
9) Remove the two mounting screws [5], and  
remove the fixing front cover [6].  
[5]  
Figure 6-205  
[7]  
10) Disconnect the connector [7], and free the  
harness from the harness guide.  
11) Remove the two mounting screws [8].  
[8]  
Figure 6-206  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
12) Lift the front of the fixing assembly [9]  
slightly to remove.  
Caution:  
When removing the fixing assembly,  
take care not to damage the feeding  
assembly.  
[9]  
Figure 6-207  
[1]  
4. Removing the Fixing Heater  
1) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
2) Disconnect the two connectors [1], and  
free the harness from the harness guide.  
3) Remove the mounting screw [2], and  
detach the heater support plate (front) [3].  
[3]  
[2]  
Figure 6-208  
4) Remove the mounting screw [4], and free  
the harness from the harness guide; then,  
detach the connector support plate [5].  
5) Disconnect all connectors [6] from the  
connector support plate [5].  
[8]  
6) Remove the mounting screw [7], and free  
the harness; then, detach the harness guide  
[8].  
[7]  
[6]  
[5]  
[4]  
Figure 6-209  
6–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
7) Free the harness from the harness retainer  
[9].  
8) Remove the two mounting screws [10],  
and detach the heater support plate (rear)  
[11].  
[10]  
[9]  
[11]  
[10]  
Figure 6-210  
9) Free the harness from the harness guide  
[12], and detach the fixing heater [13].  
Caution:  
1.Do not start work if the surface of  
the fixing heater is hot.  
2.Do not touch the surface of the  
fixing heater.  
3.If the surface of the fixing heater is  
soiled, dry wipe it.  
[12]  
[13]  
Figure 6-211  
[1]  
5. Removing the Thermal Switch  
Assembly  
1) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
2) Disconnect the two connectors [1].  
Figure 6-212  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
3) Remove the mounting screw [2], and  
detach the thermal switch assembly [3].  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 6-213  
6. Removing the Main Thermistor  
1) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
2) Remove the mounting screw [1], and free  
the harness from the harness guide; then,  
detach the main thermistor [2].  
[2]  
[1]  
[A]  
Figure 6-214  
7. Removing the Sub Thermistor  
1) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
2) Open the upper delivery assembly, and  
insert a screwdriver into the hole [A] to  
keep the upper delivery assembly from  
closing.  
Figure 6-215  
3) As shown, pick the hook assembly with  
pincers, and remove the tension spring  
[1].  
[1]  
Figure 6-216  
6–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
[3]  
4) Remove the mounting screw [2].  
5) Free the harness from the harness guide,  
and remove the sub thermistor [3].  
[2]  
Figure 6-217  
[2]  
8. Removing the Fixing Upper Roller  
1) Remove the fixing heater. (See p. 6-10.)  
2) Remove the upper delivery assembly.  
(See p. 6-16.)  
[1]  
3) Remove the lower delivery assembly (See  
p. 6-17.)  
4) Remove the three mounting screws [1],  
and remove the fixing upper inlet guide  
assembly [2].  
[1]  
Figure 6-218  
[6]  
5) Remove the double gear [3] and the C-  
ring [4]; then, detach the gear [5] and the  
bushing [6].  
[5]  
[4]  
[3]  
Figure 6-219  
[9]  
[8]  
6) Remove the C-ring [7], and detach the  
gear [8] and the bushing [9].  
[7]  
7) Remove the fixing upper roller [10].  
[10]  
Figure 6-220  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
9. Removing the Fixing Lower Roller  
1) Remove the fixing upper roller. (See p. 6-  
13.)  
2) Remove the bearing [1] and the fixing  
lower roller [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 6-221  
10.Removing the Heat Discharge  
Roller  
[1]  
[1]  
1) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
2) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
detach the fixing inlet guide assembly [2].  
[2]  
Figure 6-222  
[3]  
3) Remove the heat discharge roller [3].  
Caution:  
If you have removed the height  
adjusting screw of the inlet guide, be  
sure to perform the steps under  
“Adjusting the Height of the Fixing  
Inlet Guide.”  
Figure 6-223  
11.Adjusting the Height of the Fixing  
Inlet Guide  
[1]  
[1]  
Loosen the two adjusting screws [1], and  
adjust the height of the fixing inlet guide [2].  
[2]  
Figure 6-224  
6–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
12. Adjusting the Nip  
The nip is appropriate if it is as indicated  
in Table 6-201.  
[1]  
[1]  
If it is not as indicated, relocate the  
tension spring [1].  
Note:  
a and c are points 10 mm from both  
ends of copy paper.  
Figure 6-225  
c
Dimensions  
Measurements*  
4.8 ± 0.3mm  
Feeding  
direction  
b
b
Center of  
copy paper  
I a - c I  
0.5mm or less  
*Be sure both upper and lower rollers are  
sufficiently warm before taking measurements.  
a
Table 6-201  
Figure 6-226  
a. Measuring the Nip  
When the copier finishes warm-up, wait  
for 15 minutes. Then, make 20 A4 copies  
before measuring the nip.  
1) Place A3 copy paper in the multifeeder,  
and select the multifeeder as the source of  
paper.  
2) Open the copyboard over.  
3) Execute service mode 406 (fixing nip  
check).  
• The copy paper will be stopped when its  
leading edge is about 100 mm, and will  
automatically be discharged (See Figure  
6-226).  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
[A]  
B. Delivery Assembly  
1. Removing the Upper Separation  
Claw  
1) Remove the fixing assembly. (See p. 6-8.)  
2) Remove the stepped screw [1], and detach  
the bend [A]); then, detach the upper  
delivery assembly [2].  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 6-227  
[3]  
3) Remove the two stepped screws [3], and  
slide the upper separation claw assembly  
[4] in the direction of the arrow to  
remove.  
[3]  
[4]  
Figure 6-228  
4) Detach the spring [5], and detach the  
upper separation claw [6].  
[6]  
[5]  
Figure 6-229  
[2]  
2. Removing the Lower Separation  
Claw  
1) Remove the delivery roller. (See p. 6-17.)  
2) Remove the two stepped screws [1], and  
free the harness; then, detach the lower  
separation claw assembly [2].  
[1]  
[1]  
Figure 6-230  
6–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 FIXING SYSTEM  
[4]  
3) Detach the spring [3], and detach the  
lower separation claw [4].  
[3]  
Figure 6-231  
3. Removing the Delivery Roller  
1) Remove the two tension springs [1] and  
the two mounting screws [2]; then,  
remove the delivery roller assembly [3].  
[2] [1]  
[3]  
[1] [2]  
Figure 6-232  
2) Remove the grip ring [4], and remove the  
gear [5].  
3) Remove the two E-rings [6] and the two  
bushings [7]; then, detach the delivery  
roller [8].  
[6]  
[7]  
[6]  
[7]  
[5]  
[4]  
Figure 6-233  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
6–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7  
EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
This chapter shows the copier's external parts, and explains the principles used for the copier's various  
control mechanisms in view of the functions of electrical and mechanical units and in relation to their  
timing of operation. It also shows how these units may be disassembled/assembled and adjusted.  
I. FANS ........................................................ 7-1  
II. POWER SUPPLY..................................... 7-4  
A. Outline of Power Supply .................... 7-4  
B. Power Supply Circuitry....................... 7-5  
C. Protection Mechanisms of the  
Power Supply Circuitry....................... 7-7  
III. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY ................... 7-8  
A. External Covers.................................. 7-9  
B. Control Panel.................................... 7-13  
C. Copyboard Glass ............................. 7-14  
D. Fans.................................................. 7-15  
E. Counter Assembly ............................ 7-18  
F. Main Motor Assembly....................... 7-18  
G. DC Controller PCB ........................... 7-19  
H. Removing the Power Supply PCB ... 7-20  
I. Removing the High-Voltage Power  
Supply PCB ...................................... 7-20  
J. Lamp Regulator PCB ....................... 7-21  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
I. FANS  
The copier is equipped with three fans for cooling and discharging ozone.  
When a sorter is installed, the vent for the exhaust fan (FM2, FM4) is blocked, preventing  
discharge of ozone to the left of the copier. To enable discharge, use a sorter kit fan (FM5) to the  
front of the copier to route the ozone from the exhaust fan (FM2, FM4) to the front.  
Table 7-101 shows the function of each fan and the orientation of the fan. Figure 7-102  
shows the timing at which each fan turns on.  
FM4  
FM2  
FM5  
FM1  
Figure 7-101  
Notation  
FM1  
Name  
Cooling fan 1  
Exhaust fan 1  
Exhaust fan 2  
Sorter kit fan  
Orientation  
Blowing  
Filter  
Function  
Cools the scanner.  
Discharges exhaust.  
Air  
Ozone  
FM2  
FM4  
FM5  
Drawing  
Drawing  
Drawing  
Ozone  
Air  
*1  
*1:If a sorter kit is installed.  
Table 7-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
The exhaust fan (FM2) and the sorter kit fan (FM5) are rotated at half speed during standby  
to prevent heating inside the machine. If the reading of the cleaner thermistor (TH3) is 50°C or  
more (38°C or more if the sorter kit is installed), all fans will be rotated at full speed.  
Power switch  
ON  
Start key  
ON  
Power switch  
OFF  
Sequence  
WMUP WMUPR STBY  
INTR  
SCFW  
SCRV  
LSTR STBY  
Cooling fan 1 (FM1)  
Exhaust fan 1 (FM2)  
Exhaust fan 2 (FM4)  
Sorter kit fan (FM5)  
*1  
*1:If sorter kit is installed.  
: Full-speed rotation.  
: Half-speed rotation.  
Figure 7-102  
The speed of the exhaust fans is switched between full speed and half speed by switching the  
drive voltage of the exhaust fans as shown in Figure 7-103.  
When the CPU generates FMON=1, +24 V is supplied so that the exhaust fans (FM2, FM4,  
FM5) rotate at full speed. In response to FMHLF=1, on the other hand, +15.4 V will be supplied  
so that the exhaust fans (FM2, FM5) rotate at half speed.  
+15.4v  
+24v  
FMHLF  
IC119  
CPU  
IC113  
GA  
FMON  
FM-DRIVE  
FM-DETECT  
GND  
FM  
Fan  
DC controller PCB  
Figure 7-103  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
If the heat exhaust fan rotation detection signal (FM2ROT) is not detected 0.5 sec after the  
exhaust fan (FM2, FM4) starts to rotate, error code E805 will be indicated on the control panel.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
II. POWER SUPPLY  
A. Outline of Power Supply  
Figure 7-201 is a block diagram showing distribution of power inside the machine.  
CB1  
CB2  
LF  
SW1  
Cassette/Drum  
heater  
RL  
DS1  
Accessory  
cassette heater  
Mirror heater  
Fixing heater  
LA1  
AC  
driver  
RL1  
Lamp regulator PCB  
ADF  
+24V  
+24V  
Accessory power  
supply PCB  
Sorter  
+24V  
+5VU  
+24V  
+24V  
+24V  
AE sensor  
Sensor  
+24V  
DC power  
circuit  
Solenoid/Clutch  
Fan  
RMT  
Motor  
DC controller  
PCB  
+5VU  
+5VR  
Control panel PCB  
Pre-exposure lamp  
+24V  
J208-1  
+24V  
+24V  
+5VU  
+5VR  
-3  
-4  
Blank-exposure  
lamp  
+5VU  
+24V  
CC-IVN  
Counter  
Power supply PCB  
J210-1  
-8  
+5VU  
+24V  
HVT  
J209-4  
+24V  
Main motor  
Figure 7-201  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
B. Power Supply Circuitry  
1. AC Power Supply  
AC power is supplied to the power supply PCB when the power plug is connected and the  
front door switch (DS1) is turned on.  
2. DC Power Supply  
The power supply PCB provides three types of DC outputs: +24 V, +5 VR, and +5 VU.  
When the power plug is connected and the front door switch (DS1) is turned on, the power  
supply PCB supplies the DC controller PCB with +5 VR.  
The copier uses a soft switch as its power switch so that it continues to supply the DC  
controller PCB with +5 VR even when the power switch is off.  
When the power switch is turned on, the CPU generates the DC power supply signal.  
In response to the DC power supply signal, the power supply PCB generates +24 V and  
+5VU. This condition turns on the AC power supply relay (RL) on the power supply PCB,  
thereby making a switch-over to the fixing heater and the lamp regulator PCB.  
When the power switch is turned off, the AC power supply relay (RL) on the power supply  
PCB switches over to the options heater.  
Reference:  
The tolerance of DC voltage is as follows:  
• +24 V  
• +5 VU  
• +5 VR  
±5%  
+5%, -7%  
±5%  
However, the above applies only when the inaccuracy of the AC input is limited to ±10%.  
Caution:  
Be sure to disconnect the power plug whenever you have to replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
3. Mirror Heater, Cassette/Drum Heater, and Accessory Cassette Heater  
The following three heaters are made available as accessories to the copier, designed to  
prevent condensation of the scanner and the drum and to keep paper inside the cassette dry.  
Table 7-201 shows the function of each heater. Figure 7-202 shows the timing at which each  
heater turns on.  
Notation  
H2  
Name  
Function  
Mirror heater  
Prevents condensation on the scanner.  
Prevents condensation on the drum and keeps copy paper dry.  
Keeps copy paper dry.  
H3  
H4  
Cassette/Drum heater  
Accessory cassette heater  
Table 7-201  
Power switch  
ON  
Start key  
ON  
Power switch  
OFF  
Sequence  
WMUP WMUPR STBY  
INTR  
SCFW  
SCRV  
LSTR STBY  
Mirror heater (H2)  
Cassette/Drum heater (H3)  
Accessory Cassette heater (H4)  
Figure 7-202  
Each heater is supplied with power when the copier’s power switch is turned off. The mirror  
heater and the cassette/drum heater and the accessory cassette heater may be deprived of power  
by turning off the heater switch (SW1).  
4. ADF and Sorter  
For the ADF and the sorter, the copier’s power supply PCB supplies AC power to the  
accessory power supply PCB, which generates DC power.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
C. Protection Mechanisms of the Power Supply Circuitry  
The copier’s power supply PCB is equipped with a circuit breaker (CB1, CB2) and a fuse  
(FU1, FU2) on its AC input side. To protect against overcurrent and over voltage, the copier is  
also equipped with an overcurrent protection circuit and an over-voltage protection circuit.  
When an overcurrent or an over-voltage occurs as a result of a short circuit in the power line,  
the respective protection mechanism will turn on to stop the output of the power supply PCB.  
When the output is stopped, disconnect the copier’s power plug, and turn off the AC power  
to the power supply PCB to reset the protection mechanism.  
Caution:  
Be sure to correct the cause that turned on the protection circuit before resetting.  
Repeated short-circuiting and resetting can cause the fuse built into the power supply  
PCB to melt.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
III. DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY  
The copier may be disassembled and assembled as shown here. Pay attention to the copier’s  
mechanical characteristics along with the steps for disassembly/assembly.  
Important:  
1. Turn off the power and disconnect the power plug to ensure safety whenever  
disassembling/assembling the copier.  
2. Unless otherwise noted, assemble the parts by reversing the steps used to disassemble  
them.  
3. Identify the screws by type (length, diameter) to avoid use in the wrong location.  
4. Use a washer where needed. The mounting screws used for the grounding wire and  
varistor come with a washer to ensure electric continuity. Do not forget to use these  
washers.  
5. As a rule, do not operate the copier with any of its parts removed.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
A. External Covers  
[3]  
[1] Front cover  
[2] Right door (5)  
[3] Upper right cover (2)  
[4] Right cover (2)  
[4]  
[5] Rear cover (5)  
[6] Upper rear cover (4)  
[7] Upper left cover (2)  
[8] Delivery lower cover (2)  
[9] Delivery upper cover (2)  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 7-301  
[6]  
[7]  
The number in parentheses indicates the  
number of mounting screws used.  
[9]  
[8]  
[5]  
Figure 7-302  
[1]  
[1] Inside cover (2)  
[2] Lower inside cover (3)  
[2]  
The number in parentheses indicates the  
number of mounting screws used.  
Figure 7-303  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
Remove the appropriate covers as follows  
when cleaning, checking, or repairing the  
inside of the copier.  
Covers which may be detached by mere  
removal of mounting screws are omitted from  
the discussions.  
1. Removing the Right Door  
1) Open the right door.  
[4]  
2) Remove the four mounting screws [1],  
and remove the right door [2] and the  
paper guide [3].  
Caution:  
[3]  
When mounting the paper guide, be  
sure to fit the foot of the spring [4] at  
the rear into its hole.  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 7-304  
[1]  
2. Removing the Upper Right Cover  
1) Open the top unit.  
[3]  
[4]  
2) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
remove the right cover [2].  
3) Remove the two mounting screws [3], and  
remove the upper right cover [4].  
[2]  
Figure 7-305  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
3. Removing the Upper Left Cover  
1) Remove the copyboard glass.  
[1]  
[2]  
2) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
detach the upper left cover [2].  
Figure 7-306  
4. Removing the Delivery Lower  
Cover  
1) Open the copier top, and remove the copy  
tray.  
2) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
detach the delivery lower cover [2].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 7-307  
5. Removing the Delivery Upper  
Cover  
1) Open the copier top, and remove the  
inside cover.  
2) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
slide the delivery upper cover [2] to the  
front to remove.  
Caution:  
When mounting the delivery upper  
cover, be sure to engage the two cut-  
offs in the delivery upper cover with  
the copier’s hooks.  
[2]  
Figure 7-308  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
[2]  
6. Removing the Lower Inside Cover  
1) Remove the front door and the transfer  
charging assembly.  
[1]  
[4]  
2) Slide out the registration knob [1] to the  
front.  
3) Remove the mounting screw [2].  
4) Loosen the two mounting screws [3], and  
remove the lower inside cover [4].  
[3]  
Figure 7-309  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
B. Control Panel  
1. Removing the Control Panel  
[2]  
1) Open the copyboard cover, and remove  
the two mounting screws [1]; then, detach  
the two ADF metal catches [2].  
2) Remove the inside cover.  
[1]  
Figure 7-310  
[4]  
3) Remove the three mounting screws [3].  
4) Slide the control panel [4] to the front to  
remove; then, turn over the control panel.  
[3]  
Figure 7-311  
[5]  
5) Disconnect the three connectors [5], and  
remove the control panel.  
Figure 7-312  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
C. Copyboard Glass  
1. Removing the Copyboard Glass  
1) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
detach the glass retainer (right) [2].  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 7-313  
2) Slide the copyboard glass [3] to the right.  
3) Remove the two mounting screws [4], and  
[4]  
detach the glass retainer (left) [5].  
4) Remove the copyboard glass [3].  
[3]  
[5]  
Caution:  
When mounting the NP7161’s  
copyboard glass, make sure that the  
blue marking on the side of the glass  
is to the front left.  
Figure 7-314  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
D. Fans  
1. Removing the Scanner Cooling Fan  
1) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
detach the filter [2].  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 7-315  
2) Disconnect the connector [3], and remove  
the scanner cooling fan [4].  
[3]  
[4]  
Figure 7-316  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
2. Removing the Exhaust Fan  
1) Remove the developing assembly, drum  
unit, inside cover, and delivery upper  
cover.  
2) Disconnect the two connectors [1].  
[1]  
Figure 7-317  
3) Remove the two mounting screws [2], and  
slide the exhaust fan assembly [3] to the  
front to remove.  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 7-318  
4) Disconnect the two connectors [4], and  
remove the two exhaust fans [5].  
[4]  
Caution:  
When mounting the exhaust fan  
assembly, be sure to engage the two  
hooks on the exhaust fan assembly  
with the copier’s cut-offs.  
[5]  
Figure 7-319  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
3. Remove the Ozone Filter  
1) Open the top unit.  
2) Shift down the lever [1], and remove the  
ozone filter assembly [2].  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 7-320  
3) Remove the ozone filter [3].  
[3]  
Figure 7-321  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
E. Counter Assembly  
1. Removing the Counter Assembly  
1) Remove the control panel.  
[4]  
2) Remove the two mounting screws [1], and  
remove the magnet [2].  
3) Disconnect the two connectors [3], and  
remove the two mounting screws [4];  
then, detach the counter assembly [5].  
Caution:  
When removing the magnet, mark its  
position and mount it with reference  
[2]  
[5]  
[3]  
[1]  
to the markings.  
Figure 7-322  
[1]  
[4]  
F. Main Motor Assembly  
1. Removing the Main Motor  
Assembly  
[3]  
1) Remove the rear cover and the rear upper  
cover.  
2) Disconnect the connector [1], and remove  
the four mounting screws [2].  
3) Remove the two locking supports [3], and  
detach the main motor assembly [4].  
[2]  
Figure 7-323  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
G. DC Controller PCB  
[1]  
1. Removing the DC Controller PCB  
1) Remove the delivery lower cover.  
2) Disconnect all connectors of the DC  
controller PCB; then, free the harness  
from the harness guide.  
3) Remove the six mounting screws [1], and  
remove the DC controller PCB [2]  
together with the base plate.  
[2]  
Caution:  
Take extra care not to damage the  
harness whenever you are removing  
the DC controller PCB.  
Figure 7-324  
The DC controller PCB is equipped with  
a built-in battery (BAT101). Keep the  
following in mind to prevent its both ends  
from short circuiting and heating:  
2. Points to Note When Replacing the  
DC Controller PCB  
• When sending the DC controller to the  
workshop or the factory, put it in a  
conducting bag intact with its base  
plate.  
Use a conducting bag whose one side is  
transparent, and be sure that the face of  
the DC controller PCB shows through  
the transparent side.  
• After replacement, make adjustments  
and settings in service mode and make  
settings in user mode once again.  
• For settings in service mode, enter the  
values recorded in the Service Label  
stored behind the front door.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
H. Removing the Power  
Supply PCB  
[4]  
1. Removing the Power Supply PCB  
1) Remove the rear cover.  
2) Disconnect the fixing heater connector  
[1].  
3) Disconnect all connectors of the power  
supply PCB.  
[3]  
4) Free the AC harness [2] from the harness  
guide.  
5) Remove the four mounting screws [3],  
and detach the power supply PCB [4].  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 7-325  
I. Removing the High-Voltage  
Power Supply PCB  
1. Removing the High-Voltage Power  
Supply PCB  
[5]  
1) Remove the rear cover and the rear upper  
cover.  
2) Disconnect all connectors of the high-  
voltage power supply PCB, and remove  
the faston [1] and the high-voltage  
harness [2].  
[4]  
[2]  
[1]  
3) Remove the mounting screw [3] and the  
four locking supports [4]; then, detach the  
high-voltage power supply PCB [5].  
[3]  
Figure 7-326  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 7 EXTERNALS/AUXILIARY MECHANISMS  
J. Lamp Regulator PCB  
1. Removing the Lamp Regulator PCB  
1) Remove the rear cover.  
2) Disconnect the two connectors [1] of the  
lamp regulator PCB.  
[1]  
3) Remove the three locking supports [2],  
and detach the lamp regulator PCB [3].  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 7-327  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7160/NP7161 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
7–21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8  
INSTALLATION  
This chapter introduces requirements for the site of installation, and shows how the copier may be  
installed using step-by-step instructions.  
I. SELECTING THE SITE............................ 8-1  
II. UNPACKING AND INSTALLATION ........ 8-2  
A. Unpacking .......................................... 8-2  
B. Removing the Metal Fixings............... 8-3  
C. Mounting the Drum Unit ..................... 8-4  
D. Cleaning the Parts and Making Checks .. 8-6  
E. Checking the Images/Operations and  
IV. INSTALLING THE CONTROL  
CARD IV N ............................................. 8-13  
V. INSTALLING THE REMOTE  
DIAGNOSTIC DEVICE II .......................... 8-14  
VI. INSTALLING THE ACCESSORY  
COUNTER ................................................8-23  
VII. INSTALLING THE ACCESSORY  
User Mode .......................................... 8-8  
F. Supplying Toner ............................... 8-10  
III. RELOCATING THE MACHINE .............. 8-12  
HEATER ................................................. 8-25  
A. Installing the Heater Switch ............. 8-25  
B. Mounting the Cassette/Drum Heater 8-26  
C. Installing the Mirror Heater............... 8-27  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
I. SELECTING THE SITE  
Check the site of installation against the following requirements. If possible, visit the site in  
advance of the delivery of the machine.  
1. There must be a dedicated power outlet for exclusive use by the copier capable of providing  
the rated voltage (±10%).  
2. The temperature must be 7.5° to 32.5°C (45.5° to 90.5°F), and humidity must be 5% to 85%  
RH. (Avoid areas near a water faucet, water boiler, humidifier, and refrigerator.)  
3. Avoid areas near a source of fire and areas subject to dust or ammonia gas. Avoid direct rays  
of the sun. As necessary, provide curtains.  
4. The amount of ozone generated by the copier is of a level not affecting the health of the  
individuals around it. Some individuals, however, may find its smell unpleasant. Be sure that  
the room is properly ventilated.  
5. Select a well-ventilated area. If multiple copiers are to be installed, in particular, make sure  
that the exhaust from one will not be drawn into the vent of another.  
6. Make sure that the copier will be level.  
7. Keep the copier 10 cm (3.9 in) or more away from any wall to provide adequate space for  
machine operation.  
10cm/3.9in.  
min.  
50cm/19.7in.  
min.  
50cm/19.7in.  
min.  
50cm/19.7in.  
min.  
Figure 8-101  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
II. UNPACKING AND INSTALLATION  
When a piece of metal is brought in from a cold to warm place, droplets of water tend to  
form on its surface. This phenomenon is known as condensation, and copiers suffering from  
condensation can generate blank copies.  
If the copier has been brought in from a cold place, keep it unpacked for one hour or more  
before starting the installation work.  
The copier weighs about 42 kg/92.4 lb. Be sure to work in a group of two when lifting it.  
A. Unpacking  
Step  
1
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Open the shipping box, and take out  
the two cardboard boxes.  
2
Open the cardboard boxes, and take  
out the attachments.  
Check to make sure that none of the following is  
missing:  
• copy tray  
• power cord  
• drum unit  
• User’s Manual  
• waste toner case (3 pc.)  
• waste toner case bag (4 pc.)  
• top unit close label  
3
Holding the grips at the bottom (both  
sides), move the copier to the site of  
installation.  
Grips  
Grips  
8–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
B. Removing the Metal Fixings  
Step  
1
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Remove the packing tape, cushioning Check to make sure that the covers are free of  
material, protective sheet of the  
copyboard glass, and protective sheet  
of the size index.  
scratches and dents.  
2
Slide out the cassette, and remove the  
packing tape and the cushioning  
material from inside.  
3
4
Slide the cassette into the copier.  
Scanner fixing  
screws  
Remove the two scanner fixing screws  
from the copier’s left side. (Store  
away the scanner fixing screw for  
possible relocation of the machine.)  
5
Open the front door, and shift up the  
opening/closing lever to open the  
copier top.  
Main unit lever  
Remove the metal fixing from the  
opening/closing hook (right). (You  
will not be using the removed metal  
fixing.)  
Cushioning material  
Pressure  
release plate (front)  
6
While opening the delivery assembly,  
remove the fixing assembly releasing  
plate (1 each at front and rear). (You  
will not be using the removed fixing  
assembly releasing plate.)  
Pressure  
release plate (rear)  
Fixing  
delivery  
assembly  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
C. Mounting the Drum Unit  
Step  
1
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Turn the toner supply lever  
counterclockwise to unlock the  
developing assembly.  
Toner supply  
lever  
2
Remove the thumb screw, and remove  
the dummy drum. (You will be using  
the thumb screw when mounting the  
drum unit. Store away the dummy  
drum for possible relocation of the  
machine.)  
Thumb screw  
Dummy  
drum  
3
Take out the drum unit from the box, Keep the labels for later use.  
and remove the cushioning material  
and the protective sheet.  
Caution:  
• Take care not to damage the  
surface of the photosensitive  
drum.  
• Take care not to subject the  
photosensitive drum to light  
unnecessarily.  
4
Set the drum unit to the copier by  
sliding it along the rails, and secure it  
in place using the thumb screw used  
to fix the dummy drum in place.  
Thumb screw  
Drum  
unit  
8–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
Step  
5
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Fill out the label that came with the  
drum unit, and attach the label to the  
front cover of the drum unit.  
date  
counter  
notes  
Notiz  
date  
Datum compteur Zahler  
note  
6
Turn the toner supply lever clockwise  
to lock the developing assembly in  
place; then, close the copier top.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
D. Cleaning the Parts and Making Checks  
Step  
1
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Clean the charging wire using the  
primary charging wire cleaning lever.  
2
Clean the charging wire using the  
transfer charging wire leaning lever.  
3
Take out the static eliminator, and  
clean it using the static eliminator  
cleaner stored behind the front door.  
Thereafter, set the static eliminator  
and the static eliminator cleaner back  
to their initial positions.  
Clean as if to sweep the inside of the groove of  
the static eliminator.  
Static eliminator  
cleaning brush  
4
Remove the inside cover (2 screws).  
Screws  
8–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
Step  
5
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Take out the dust-proofing glass (1  
screw), and dry wipe it with lint-free  
paper. Then, mount it back to the  
copier.  
Screw  
6
7
Mount the inside cover.  
Turn the toner supply lever  
counterclockwise to unlock the  
developing assembly.  
Toner  
supply  
lever  
8
Remove the stopper (1 screw), and  
take out the developing assembly.  
Check to make sure that the developing cylinder  
is free of soiling and scratches.  
Stopper  
Screw  
Caution:  
• Do not touch the developing  
cylinder.  
• Take care not to damage the  
developing cylinder.  
Developing  
assembly  
9
Set the developing assembly in the  
copier by sliding it along the rails;  
then, mount the stopper.  
10 Turn the toner supply lever clockwise  
to lock the developing assembly in  
place.  
11 Close the front door.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
E. Checking the Images/Operations and User Mode  
Step  
1
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Connect the power cord to the copier,  
and connect the power plug to the  
outlet.  
2
Turn on the power switch.  
• Check to make sure that the Paper indicator  
flashes.  
• Press the keys on the numeric keypad and  
the Clear key to make sure that copy counts  
are indicated correctly.  
3
4
Supply toner.  
See F. “Supplying Toner.”  
In standby state, execute service mode  
401 (stir toner).  
• This mode lasts about 4 min.  
• While this mode is effective, ‘401’ is  
indicated; upon completion, ‘4’ of ‘401’ is  
flashed.  
Steps  
1) Press the User mode key.  
2) Hold down ‘2’ and ‘8’ on the  
numeric keypad at the same time  
for 0.5 sec or more.  
Caution:  
While the mode remains on, do not turn off  
the power or open the front door.  
3) Press the user mode key.  
4) Check to see that ‘1’ is indicated.  
5) Press ‘4’ on the numeric keypad.  
6) Check to see that ‘4’ is indicated.  
7) Press the AE key.  
8) Check to make sure that ‘401’ is  
indicated.  
9) Press the Start key to start  
stirring toner.  
5
Execute service mode 403 drum unit  
installation mode.  
• This mode lasts about 40 sec.  
• While this mode is effective, ‘403’ is  
indicated; upon completion, ‘4’ of ‘403’ is  
flashed.  
Steps  
1) Check to see that ‘401’ is  
indicated.  
2) Press ‘3’ on the numeric keypad.  
3) Check to see that ‘403’ is  
indicated.  
Caution:  
While the mode remains on, do not turn off  
the power or open the front door.  
4) Press the Start key to start drum  
unit installation mode.  
8–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
Step  
6
Work  
Checks/remarks  
While the toner is being stirred,  
perform the following:  
To switch the cassette between AB and Inch, see  
the instructions under “Changing the Cassette  
Size (AB/Inch). (See p. 5-25.)  
1)Set the cassette size to suit the  
needs of the user, and put copy  
paper inside the cassette.  
2)Mount the copy tray to the  
copier.  
Copy tray  
7
8
When drum unit installation mode has  
been executed, press the Reset key to  
end service mode.  
Place the Test Sheet on the copyboard  
glass, and make copies using each  
cassette. Then, check the copy images.  
• Check to make sure that there is no  
abnormal noise.  
• Check to make sure that as many copies as  
set are made normally.  
• Check the copies (images) made at each  
default reproduction ratio.  
If images are not optimum, perform the  
“Image Adjustment Basic Procedure.” (p.  
10-3)  
• Check to make sure that copying operation  
in each copying mode is normal.  
• Check to make sure that the counter operates  
normally.  
9
Make user mode settings and service  
mode settings 5 to suit the user's  
needs.  
10 Clean up the area around the machine.  
11 If you are installing accessories (e.g.,  
sorter), install them according to their  
respective Installation Procedures.  
12 Fill out the Service Sheet.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
F. Supplying Toner  
Step  
1
Work  
Open the front door.  
Checks/remarks  
2
3
4
Turn the toner supply lever  
counterclockwise to unlock the  
developing assembly.  
Tonner  
supply lever  
Holding the grip, pull the developing  
assembly to the front until it stops.  
Handle  
Holding the toner cartridge horizontal,  
shake it left and right several times.  
5
Put the toner cartridge over the  
developing assembly, and push it in  
fully to the rear.  
8–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
Step  
6
Work  
Checks/remarks  
Push the toner cartridge from above to Check to make sure that the opening tab of the  
lock it to the developing assembly.  
toner cartridge has sprung to the front.  
7
Pull the opening tab to the front until  
the STOP line is in view.  
8
Tap lightly on the top of the toner  
cartridge so that the toner falls into the  
developing assembly.  
9
Push in the grip of the developing  
assembly so that the toner cartridge  
may be detached.  
The toner cartridge will detach itself from the  
developing assembly when the grip of the  
developing assembly is pushed in to its initial  
position.  
10 Slide the developing assembly into the  
copier, and turn the toner supply lever  
clockwise to lock the developing  
assembly in place.  
11 Close the front door.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
III. RELOCATING THE MACHINE  
If you need to relocate the machine by truck or any other means of transportation, perform  
the following:  
Step  
1
Work  
Checks  
Remarks  
Make a copy in Direct.  
2
Take out all copy paper from the  
cassette.  
3
Excute ‘403’ in service mode.  
The scanner, lens, and No.4/No.5  
mirror unit move to the position for  
transportation.  
4
5
6
Turn off the power switch, and  
disconnect the power plug from the  
power outlet.  
Secure the scanner in place using the  
two scanner fixing screws from the  
left side of the copier.  
Use the screws  
removed during  
installation work.  
Take out the drum unit, and mount the The drum unit must be  
dummy drum.  
transported separately.  
7
8
Remove the copy tray.  
Tape the front door, multifeeder tray,  
and cassette in place.  
9
Place A3 copy paper on the  
copyboard glass, and tape the  
copyboard in place.  
8–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
IV. INSTALLING THE  
CONTROL CARD IV N  
1) Remove the screw [1] from the right side  
of the upper rear cover, and detach the  
face cover [2].  
2) Cut off the face plate [3].  
[3]  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 8-401  
3) Lead out the harness, and disconnect the  
shorting connector [4]; then, connect the  
connector [5] of the Control Card IV N to  
the copier’s connector [6].  
[6]  
[4]  
[5]  
Figure 8-402  
4) Push in the harness and the connector into  
the copier, and install the Control Card IV  
N to the copier using the screw [7].  
[7]  
Figure 8-403  
5) Connect the copier’s power plug, and turn  
on the power switch to check the  
operation of the Control Card IV N.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
V. INSTALLING THE REMOTE DIAGNOSTIC DEVICE II  
Keep the following in mind when installing the Remote Diagnostic Device II to the copier:  
1. Be sure to observe the relevant laws and regulations of the country.  
2. Be sure to check that the copier has properly been installed before starting the work.  
3. Be sure to keep the copier’s power plug disconnected during the work.  
4. Be sure to identify the screws by type (length, diameter) and location.  
5. Be sure to set the settings data to the computer at the service station in advance.  
8–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
[2]  
1) Remove the two screws [1], and detach  
the top cover [2].  
[1]  
[1]  
Figure 8-501  
[4]  
2) Connect the connector [3] of the power  
supply unit to the connector [4] as shown.  
[3]  
Figure 8-502  
3) Remove the copier’s rear cover; then,  
remove the sheet [5], and cut off the face  
plate [6].  
[5]  
[6]  
Figure 8-503  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
4) Lead the harness through the opening in  
the rear cover made by cutting off the face  
plate in step 3), and connect the connector  
[7] and the copier’s connector [8] (8P).  
(At this time, be sure to fit the harness in  
the harness guide as shown.)  
[8]  
[7]  
Figure 8-504  
5) Mount the rear cover and the grounding  
wire [9] (attachment) to the copier, and  
secure the device to the rear cover  
together with the grounding wire [9] with  
four screws [10] (use the screws that  
come with the device).  
[10]  
[9]  
Figure 8-505  
6) Remove the slack from the cable between  
the copier and the device, and bundle  
together any excess length and secure it in  
place with the harness band [11].  
[11]  
Figure 8-506  
8–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
7) Shift bits 4 of the DIP switch (SW2) [12]  
on the device’s PCB to ON (so that the  
communication with the copier will be  
IPC communication).  
[12]  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-507  
8) If IC6 [13] is mounted on the PCB, shift  
bit 7 of the DIP switch (SW2) to ON;  
otherwise, keep bit 7 at OFF.  
[14]  
Caution:  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1.If the ROM (IC6) [13] is not mounted,  
you need not mount one newly.  
2.If you want to mount the ROM (IC6)  
[13] for upgrading or replace it, be sure  
to shift bit 7 of the DIP switch [14]  
(SW2) to ON.  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
[13]  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-508  
9) Set each bit of the DIP switch (SW3) [15]  
as indicated in Table 8-501.  
[15]  
Switch Setting  
Description  
SW3-1  
SW3-2  
SW3-3  
AII  
OFF  
ON  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
SW4  
LED6  
LED4  
ON  
selects push pulse for RDD circuit  
confihuration  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
SW3-4  
selscts dial pulse for RDD circuit  
confihuration  
OFF  
CN3  
CN2  
sets dial pulse speed to 20 PPS  
sets dial pulse speed to 10 PPS  
reserved  
ON  
OFF  
SW3-5  
SW3-6  
Figure 8-509  
Table 8-501  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
[16]  
10) Connect the power supply unit to the  
power plug, and check to make sure that  
LED1 [16] (green) turns on.  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-510  
11) Execute RAM clear.  
[17]  
Set each bit of the DIP switch [17] (SW2)  
as indicated in Table 8-502, and press the  
push switch [18] (SW4). A press should  
turn on LED5 [19] (red).  
[19]  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
SW4  
LED6  
LED4  
SW2 bits  
SW2-1  
SW2-2  
SW2-3  
SW2-4  
SW2-5  
SW2-6  
SW2-7  
SW2-8  
Settings  
OFF  
IC6  
[18]  
CN4  
SW1  
OFF  
CN3  
CN2  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
Figure 8-511  
ON  
See step 9).  
OFF  
Table 8-502  
8–18  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
12) After making sure that LED5 [19] (red)  
has turned on, set each bit of the DIP  
switch [17] (SW2) as indicated in Table  
8-503, and press the push switch [18]  
(SW4). A press should turn off LED5 [19]  
(red), indicating that RAM clear has  
ended.  
[17]  
[19]  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
SW4  
LED6  
LED4  
[18]  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
SW2 bits  
SW2-1  
SW2-2  
SW2-3  
SW2-4  
SW2-5  
SW2-6  
SW2-7  
SW2-8  
Settings  
OFF  
CN3  
CN2  
OFF  
ON  
Figure 8-512  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
See step 9).  
OFF  
Table 8-503  
13) Shift bit 6 of the DIP switch [20] (SW2)  
to OFF.  
[20]  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-513  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
14) Connect the telephone line to the device.  
If the device is connected on its own,  
connect the modular jack cable to the  
connector LINE [21].  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
If the extension function of the device is  
used, connect the existing telephone or  
fax to the connector TEL [22], and  
connect the telephone line to the  
connector LINE [21].  
CN3  
CN2  
[21]  
[22]  
Figure 8-514  
15) Call the service station, and request initial  
settings for the device. (Upon reception,  
LED4 [23] (red) will start to flash.)  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
[23]  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-515  
16) Call the service station to find out whether  
the initial settings have been successfully  
made. Otherwise, execute RAM clear  
(steps 11) through 13) ) once again and  
start over.  
Caution:  
Upon completion of each try, check  
with the service station to make sure  
that the settings have been made  
successfully.  
8–20  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
17) Check if the device is capable of ringing  
up the computer at the service station.  
Press the push switch [18] (SW4).  
A press will turn on LED6 [24] (red): it  
will turn off upon completion of  
transmission, and it will flash upon  
failure.  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
[24]  
IC6  
CN4  
[18]  
SW1  
[25]  
CN3  
CN2  
Another press on the push switch (SW4)  
[18] while LED6 [24] is flashing will  
initiate transmission once again.  
A press on the push switch (SW1) [25]  
while LED 6 [24] is flashing will cancel  
transmission attempts.  
Figure 8-516  
18) Check to make sure that the  
[26]  
communication with the copier is normal.  
Connect the copier’s power plug, and turn  
on the power switch to see that LED2 [26]  
(orange) flashes.  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
LED6  
LED4  
SW4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-517  
19) Press the copier’s Copy Start key so that  
LED3 [27] (pink) flashes in response.  
[27]  
LED1 LED2 LED3  
2
6
1
BAT1  
1
1
2
SW3  
SW2  
LED5  
SW4  
LED6  
LED4  
IC6  
CN4  
SW1  
CN3  
CN2  
Figure 8-518  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
[30]  
20) Attach the switch settings label [28] on  
the device, and record the settings of each  
switch.  
[28]  
[29]  
21) Secure the top cover [29] in place with  
two screws [30]. At this time, check to  
make sure that the cable is fixed in place  
with the cable guide and is not trapped by  
the top cover [29].  
[30]  
Figure 8-519  
8–22  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
VI. INSTALLING THE  
ACCESSORY  
COUNTER  
[1]  
1) Open the front door; then, remove the  
inside cover, and cut off the face plate [1].  
Figure 8-601  
[2]  
2) Remove the delivery lower cover, and  
mount the accessory counter [2] to the  
counter assembly.  
Figure 8-602  
[3]  
[4]  
3) Connect the connector [3] of the  
accessory counter to the connector [4] of  
the counter assembly.  
Figure 8-603  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
4) Remove the delivery lower cover, and set  
the DIP switch (SW102) on the DC  
controller PCB as indicated in Table 8-  
601.  
SW102-5 SW102-6  
Settings  
OFF  
OFF  
Accessory counter not  
connected.  
Uses the accessory  
counter as a small-size  
copy counter.  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
Uses the accessory  
counter as a large-size  
copy counter.  
Not used  
Table 8-601  
5) Mount the delivery lower cover and the  
inside cover, and close the front door.  
6) Connect the copier’s power plug, and turn  
on the power switch to check the  
operation of each counter.  
8–24  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
VII.INSTALLING THE  
ACCESSORY HEATER  
A. Installing the Heater Switch  
1) Remove the rear cover, and cut off the  
face plate [1].  
[1]  
Figure 8-701  
[3]  
[2]  
2) Mount the heater switch [2] with two  
screws [3].  
Figure 8-702  
[4]  
3) Lead the heater switch harness through  
the clamp, and connect it to the connector  
[4].  
Figure 8-703  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
B. Mounting the Cassette/  
Drum Heater  
1) Remove the front door, drum unit,  
developing assembly, transfer charging  
assembly, and cassette.  
2) Engage the two hooks [1] of the cassette/  
drum heater on the cut-off, and slide to  
the rear to mount.  
[1]  
Figure 8-704  
[2]  
3) Secure with two mounting screws [2].  
Figure 8-705  
[3]  
4) Lead the cassette/drum heater harness [3]  
through the harness guide, and connect  
the connector [4].  
[4]  
Figure 8-706  
8–26  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 8 INSTALLATION  
C. Installing the Mirror Heater  
[1]  
[2]  
1) Mount the inside cover and the delivery  
upper cover.  
2) Mount the mirror heater [1] with two  
screws [2].  
Figure 8-707  
3) Lead the mirror heater harness [3] through  
the harness guide, and connect the  
connector [4].  
[3]  
[4]  
Figure 8-708  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
8–27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9  
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
This chapter provides tables of periodically replaced parts and consumables/durables and scheduled  
servicing charts.  
I. PERIODICALLY REPLACED PARTS ..... 9-1  
A. Copier ................................................. 9-1  
II. CONSUMABLES AND DURABLES ........ 9-2  
A. Copier ................................................. 9-2  
III. SCHEDULED SERVICING CHART ........ 9-3  
IV. SCHEDULED SERVICING TABLE ......... 9-5  
A. Copier ................................................. 9-5  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
I. PERIODICALLY REPLACED PARTS  
Some of the parts of the copier need to be replaced on a periodical basis to ensure a specific  
level of performance (regardless of external appearance or presence/absence of damage).  
Plan replacement so that it coincides with a scheduled servicing visit.  
A. Copier  
As of August 1998  
Remarks  
Q’ty  
AR  
1
Expected life (copies)  
60,000  
No.  
1
Parts name  
Parts No.  
Transfer charging wire  
Ozone filter (exhaust)  
FY3-0040-000  
FE5-3956-000  
60,000  
Or, 1 yr.  
2
Note:  
The above values are estimates only, and are subject to change based on future data.  
COPYRIGHT © 1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
9–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
II. CONSUMABLES AND DURABLES  
Some of the parts of the copier may need to be replaced once or more because of wear or  
damage over the period of machine warranty. Replace them when they fail.  
A. Copier  
As of August 1998  
Remarks  
Q’ty  
1
Expected life (copies)  
No.  
1
Parts name  
Scanning lamp  
Parts No.  
120V  
230V  
FH7-3360-000  
FH7-3361-000  
FE5-4199-000  
RF5-2490-000  
RF5-2490-000  
FB1-8581-000  
FE5-4132-000  
FL5-0581-000  
120,000  
120,000  
120,000  
120,000  
120,000  
120,000  
120,000  
60,000  
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
Pick-up roller  
1
Feed roller  
1
Separation roller  
Multifeeder pick-up roller  
Multifeeder separation pad  
Static eliminator  
1
1
Come with  
the packing  
of drum unit  
1
1
1
1
5
4
1
1
8
9
Developing cylinder  
Fixing upper roller  
FM5-0721-000  
FE5-3912-000  
FE5-3905-000  
FB1-7075-000  
FA2-9037-000  
FE5-3932-000  
FE5-3927-000  
180,000  
180,000  
180,000  
180,000  
180,000  
120,000  
120,000  
10 Fixing lower roller  
11 Fixing upper separation claw  
12 Fixing lower separation claw  
13 Heat discharge roller  
14 Delivery roller  
Note:  
The above values are estimates only, and are subject to change based on future data.  
9–2  
COPYRIGHT © 1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
III. SCHEDULED SERVICING CHART  
Note:  
1. As a rule, provide scheduled servicing every 60,000 copies.  
2. Before setting out for a visit, check the Servicing Book, and take parts for which  
replacement is expected.  
Step  
Work  
Checks  
Remarks  
Check the general condition.  
1
2
3
Report to the person in charge.  
Record the counter reading.  
Check the faulty copies.  
a. density of images  
b.soiling of the background  
c. clarity of characters  
d.margin along the leading  
edge  
Make test copies (in Direct, Reduce,  
Enlarge).  
e. margin on the left/right  
f. fixing, registration  
(displacement), soling of  
backs  
g.abnormal noise  
h.counter operation  
4
Clean the optical assembly:  
• canning reflecting plate  
• lens  
Use a blower brush; if dirt is  
excessive, use alcohol.  
• No. 1/2/3/4/5/6 mirror  
• dust-proofing glass  
Collect the waste toner case is full.  
5
6
Check the waste toner case.  
Replace the transfer charging wire,  
clean the transfer charging guide, and  
clean the transfer guide:  
Dry wipe with lint-free paper ;  
if necessary use alcohol.  
• transfer guide (upper/lower) plate  
• transfer/separation charging  
assembly guide rail  
7
8
9
Clean the separation/feeding assembly:  
• separation static eliminator  
• feeding assembly  
Clean the fixing/delivery assembly:  
• fixing (upper/lower) roller  
• separation claw (upper/lower)  
Lubricant  
Provide scheduled servicing according  
to the number of copies made.  
COPYRIGHT © 1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
9–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
Step  
Work  
Checks  
Remarks  
Use alcohol.  
10  
Clean the copyboard cover and the  
copyboard glass.  
11  
12  
13  
Make test copies.  
Make sample copies.  
Put the sample copies in order, and  
clean up the area around the machine.  
14  
15  
Record the latest counter reading.  
Fill out the Service Sheet, and report to  
the person in charge.  
9–4  
COPYRIGHT © 1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
IV. SCHEDULED SERVICING TABLE  
A. Copier  
Caution:  
1. Do not use solvents/oils other than those mentioned herein.  
2. Keep the following in mind when cleaning/checking each charging assembly:  
• Do not use a cloth having metal powder.  
• Do not use a moist cloth. Dry wipe with lint-free paper, and use alcohol thereafter. Be  
sure that alcohol has dried completely before mounting back to the copier.  
: Adjust  
Intervals  
: Inspect  
yearly  
: Clean  
: Replace  
Item  
: Lubricate  
Unit  
Remarks  
every  
every  
every  
60,000 120,000 180,000  
Copyboard glass  
Copyboard cover  
Ozone filter  
Externals  
Or, 1 yr.  
Scanner drive  
assembly  
Scanner drive cable  
(front/rear)  
Scanner rail  
Use alcohol, and apply lubricant.  
Use a blower brush.  
If the dirt is excessive,  
use alcohol.  
Scanning lamp  
No. 1 to 16 mirrors  
Dust-proofing glass  
Scanner reflecting cover  
Scanner side reflecting  
plate  
Optical path  
Lens  
Developing assembly roll  
Developing cylinder  
Waste toner box  
Developing  
assembly  
Replaced by the user in  
response to an alarm.  
Cleaner  
Pick-up roller  
Pick-up  
assembly  
Pick-up feed roller  
Pick-up separation roller  
Multifeeder pick-up roller  
Multifeeder separation pad  
Transfer guide  
Feeding assembly  
Fixing assembly  
Fixing upper roller  
Fixing lower roller  
Separation claw  
(upper/lower)  
Look for damage on the claw  
tip and for soiling by toner.  
Heat roller  
Delivery roller  
COPYRIGHT © 1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
9–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 9 MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING  
Intervals  
Unit  
Others  
Item  
Remarks  
every  
every  
every  
yearly  
60,000 120,000 180,000  
Transfer charging wire  
Static eliminator  
9–6  
COPYRIGHT © 1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
This chapter provides tables of maintenance/inspection, standards/adjustments, and identification of  
problems (image fault/malfunction).  
I. GUIDE TO TROUBLESHOOTING  
A. Sensors and Switches ................... 10-70  
B. Motors, Fans, Clutches,  
and Solenoids................................. 10-72  
C. Heaters, Lamps, and Others .......... 10-74  
D. PCBs .............................................. 10-76  
E. Variable Resistors, Light-Emitting  
TABLES .................................................. 10-1  
A. Image Adjustment Basic Procedure 10-3  
B. Points to Note for Scheduled Servicing . 10-4  
II. STANDARDS AND ADJUSTMENTS .... 10-5  
A. Mechanical ....................................... 10-5  
B. Exposure System ............................. 10-7  
C. Image Formation System ............... 10-10  
D. Pick-Up/Feeding System ............... 10-14  
E. Fixing System ................................. 10-16  
F. Electrical System............................ 10-18  
III. IMAGE FAULTS ................................... 10-25  
A. Initial Checks .................................. 10-25  
B. Image Fault Samples ..................... 10-28  
C. Troubleshooting Image Faults ....... 10-29  
IV. TROUBLESHOOTING  
MALFUNCTIONS ................................. 10-42  
A. Copier ............................................. 10-42  
V. TROUBLESHOOTING FEEDING  
PROBLEMS.......................................... 10-66  
A. Copy Jams ..................................... 10-66  
B. Faulty Feeding................................ 10-69  
VI. ARRANGEMENT AND FUNCTIONS  
OF ELECTRICAL PARTS .................... 10-70  
Diodes, and Check Pins by PCB ... 10-77  
VII. SERVICE MODE .................................. 10-82  
A. Outline ............................................ 10-82  
B. Using Service Mode ....................... 10-82  
C. Using Adjust Mode and  
Function Mode................................ 10-83  
D. Display Mode [1] ............................ 10-84  
E. I/O Display Mode [2]....................... 10-88  
F. Adjust Mode [3] .............................. 10-92  
G. Function Mode [4] .......................... 10-94  
H. Option Mode [5].............................. 10-95  
I. Counter Mode [6] ........................... 10-97  
J. Application Mode [7]....................... 10-98  
VIII. SELF DIAGNOSIS .............................. 10-99  
A. Copier ............................................. 10-99  
B. ADF .............................................. 10-103  
C. Sorter ............................................ 10-104  
D. Cassette Feeding Module ............ 10-104  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
I. GUIDE TO TROUBLESHOOTING TABLES  
The troubleshooting tables in this chapter are based on more commonly used troubleshooting  
flow charts.  
Study the following for an idea of how you may take advantage of the tables.  
EX:  
AC power is absent.  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
NO  
Actions  
Power plug  
Is the power plug connected to  
the power outlet?  
Connect the power  
plug.  
Covers  
Are the front door and delivery  
cover closed properly?  
Close the door and  
the cover properly.  
2
3
NO  
NO  
Power source  
Is the rated voltage present at the  
power outlet?  
This is not the copier's  
problem. Inform the  
user accordingly.  
4
Is the rated voltage present between YES  
J1-1 and J1-2? (J1 is found near  
the power cord mount.)  
Go to step 6.  
Rest omitted.  
If you want to find out the possible causes (faulty parts) associated with a specific problem,  
see the items under “Cause.”  
In the case of the above, i.e., “AC power is absent,” you may suspect the power plug,  
doors and covers, or power source.  
If you want to find out the checks to make or the actions to take for a specific problem,  
follow the instructions under “Checks” and “Actions” in sequence. Answer the question  
Yes or No, and if your answer matches the answer given under “Yes/No,” take the action  
given under “Actions”; otherwise, go to the next step and work likewise.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
NO  
Actions  
Is the  
power plug connected  
to the power outlet?  
Connect the power plug.  
YES  
Is the front  
NO  
NO  
2
3
Close the door properly.  
door closed properly?  
YES  
Is the rated  
voltage present  
at the power outlet?  
This is not the copier’s  
problem. Inform the user  
accordingly.  
YES  
Rest omitted  
The instruction “Measure the voltage between J109-1 (+) and J109-2 (-) on the DC  
controller PCB” means you are expected to make the following connections:  
Connect the positive probe of your meter to J109-1 (+), and  
Connect the negative probe of your meter to J109-2 (-).  
10–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Image Adjustment Basic Procedure  
Non-AE, Copy Density at 5  
Pre-Checks  
Density Slope Adjustment  
Solid Black Density Adjustment Optimum Exposure Adjustment  
Clean the charging wires.  
Is there  
Is the density  
of gray scale No. 1  
too low (light)?  
Is the density  
of gray scale No.  
10 optimum?  
Is the white  
background  
foggy?  
NO  
NO  
YES  
NO  
a difference in density  
between front and  
rear?  
YES  
YES  
NO  
YES  
Check the height of  
the charging wire.  
*1*2  
See “Preventing Image  
Faults.” (p. 10-32)  
Turn the adjusting screw at  
the front/rear of the primary  
charging assembly counterc  
lockwise so that the primary  
charging wire is closer to  
the photosensitive drum.  
Is the density  
of gray scale No. 10 too  
high (dark)?  
NO  
NO  
Is the rear  
lighter?  
Set the setting of ‘U12:  
density correction’ in  
user mode to a standard  
setting.  
Perform AE  
adjustment. (p. 10-19)  
YES  
YES  
*1*2  
*1*2  
Turn the adjusting screw at  
the rear of the primary  
changing assembly counter-  
clockwise and the adjusting  
screw at the front clockwise  
(1.0 mm max. each).  
Turn the adjusting screw at  
Increase the setting of  
‘scanning lamp ON  
voltage adjustment’  
in service mode (326).  
Decrease the setting of  
‘scanning lamp ON  
voltage adjustment’  
in service mode (326).  
the rear of the primary  
Make two to three copies  
of the Test Sheet (NA-3).  
Make a copy.  
charging assembly clockwise  
and the adjusting screw at  
the front counterclockwise  
(1.0 mm max. each).  
Make a copy.  
Make a copy.  
1: If there still is a difference after turning the adjusting screw 1.0 mm  
each*, check the charging assembly, scanning lamp, and scanner for dirt.  
*A full turn causes a change of 0.5 mm.  
2: When turning the adjusting screw clockwise, be careful that the height  
of the charging wire is not less than 10.0 mm.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B. Points to Note for Scheduled Servicing  
Part  
Copyboard glass  
Lens  
Scanner rail  
Reflecting plate  
No. 1 to 3 mirrors  
Tool/solvent  
Alcohol  
Blower brush  
Lubricant  
Blower brush  
Blower brush; or,  
alcohol and lint-free brush; if excessive,  
Remarks  
Part  
Static eliminator  
Dust-proofing glass Blower brush or  
No. 4 to 6 mirrors  
Tool/solvent  
Brush (attachment) Cleaning  
Remarks  
Cleaning  
Cleaning  
Cleaning with a blower  
alcohol and lint-free brush; if excessive,  
paper cleaning with alcohol.  
Alcohol and lint-free Dry wiping; then, cleaning  
Lubricate  
Cleaning  
Charging wire  
Cleaning with a blower  
paper  
with lint-free paper  
moistened with alcohol  
paper  
cleaning with alcohol  
Developing rol  
Cleaning  
Part  
Separation claw  
(upper/lower)  
Fixing upper roller,  
Fixing lower roller  
Tool/solvent  
Remarks  
Cleaning  
Part  
Tool/solvent  
Remarks  
Cleaning  
Separation roller  
Feed roller  
Pick-up roller  
Multifeeder pick-up roller  
Transfer guide  
Lubricant and  
lint-free paper  
Lint-free paper  
Dry wiping  
Moist cloth  
Cleaning  
Part  
Tool/solvent  
Remarks  
Waste toner box  
Checking/collecting  
10–4  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
II. STANDARDS AND ADJUSTMENTS  
A. Mechanical  
1. Leading Edge Non-Image Width (blank exposure lamp off timing)  
Select No. 306 in service mode.  
Make adjustments so that non-image width on copies made of the Test Sheet in Direct is 2.0 ±1.0mm.  
[unit: 0.21 mm]  
[settings: 0 to 500]  
2.0±1.0mm  
Figure 10-201  
2. Image Leading Edge Margin (registration on timing)  
Select No. 305 in service mode.  
Make adjustments so that the image leading edge margin on copies made of the Test Sheet in  
Direct is 2.5 ±1.5 mm.  
[unit: 0.21 mm]  
[settings: 0 to 500]  
2.5±1.5mm  
Figure 10-202  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3. Left/Right Registration (cassette)  
Make adjustments by moving the horizontal registration adjusting screw of the cassette so  
that the distance between the copy image and the copy paper is 0 ±2.0 mm on copies made of the  
Test Sheet in Direct.  
Turn the adjusting screw [1] until the cassette locking lever plate [2] and the cassette locking  
lever [3] engage.  
When the adjusting screw [1] is turned clockwise, the cassette locking plate moves to the  
front.  
When the adjusting screw [1] is turned counterclockwise, the cassette locking lever plate [2]  
moves to the rear.  
[1]  
[2]  
[3]  
Figure 10-203  
(-)  
(+)  
0
2
4
6
8
10  
Figure 10-204  
10–6  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
B. Exposure System  
1. Routing the Scanner Drive Cable  
Route the cable following steps [1] through [7], and perform the steps under “Adjusting the  
Tension of the Cable” and “Adjusting the Position of the Mirror.”  
[3]  
[4]  
Secure temporarily.  
[1]  
Steel ball  
Wind 11 times.  
[2]  
[6]  
[5]  
[2]  
[7]  
[6]  
Figure 10-205  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
2. Adjusting the Position of the Mirror  
Be sure to adjust the position of the mirror as follows after you have mounted the scanner  
drive cable.  
1) Keep the mirror positioning tool nearby.  
Arrange the mirror positioning tool (FY9-3009-050) as shown to adapt it to the copier.  
Figure 10-206b (Front)  
Figure 10-206a (Rear)  
2) Fit the mirror positioning tool [1] to the No. 1 mirror base and the No. 2 mirror base (both  
front and rear).  
3) Tighten the mounting screw [2] on the cable metal fixing of the No. 1 mirror base (both front  
and rear).  
[2]  
[2]  
[1]  
[1]  
Figure 10-207a (Rear)  
Figure 10-207b (Front)  
4) Detach the mirror positioning tool.  
10–8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3. Adjusting the Tension of the Scanner Drive Cable  
Be sure to adjust the tension as follows after routing the scanner drive cable.  
1) Move the scanner to home position.  
2) Pull the center of the scanner drive cable with a spring gauge about 10 mm. At this time,  
adjust the position [A] of the tension spring [1] so that the reading of the spring gauge is 95 ±15 g.  
10mm  
10mm  
Figure 10-208  
[A]  
[1]  
[1]  
Figure 10-209  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
C. Image Formation System  
1. Outline  
As many as two charging wires are located around the photosensitive drum. (These charging  
wires are 0.06 mm in diameter.)  
2. Stringing the Charging Wires  
Basically, all charging wires are strung in the same way. (The following uses the primary  
charging wire as an example.)  
1) Remove the mounting screw [1], and remove the stopper [2] and the grid plate [3].  
To remove the transfer charging assembly, remove the three hooks [a], and remove the guide  
wire plate [b].  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
[1]  
[a]  
[a]  
[a]  
[3]  
[2]  
[b]  
Figure 10-210b  
Figure 10-210a  
2) Remove the sheet (front) [4] and the sheet (rear) [5].  
To remove the transfer charging assembly, remove the sheet (front) [c] and the sheet (rear) [d].  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
[c]  
[d]  
[5]  
[4]  
Figure 10-211b  
Figure 10-211a  
10–10  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3) Remove the spring [6], and remove the charging wire [7].  
To remove the transfer charging assembly, remove the spring [e], and remove the charging  
wire [f].  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
[e]  
[7]  
[6]  
[f]  
Figure10-212a  
Figure 10-212b  
4) Free a length of about 5 cm of charging wire (0.06-mm dia.) from the reel, and form a loop at  
the end (2-mm dia.).  
Note:  
To form a loop easily, wind the charging wire around a hex key once; then, turn the hex  
key three to four times, and twist the charging wire.  
5) Cut the excess end of the twisted charging wire with a nipper.  
6) Hook the loop on the charging electrode at the rear.  
Figure 10-213  
7) Hook the charging wire on the charging wire positioner at the rear; then, pull on the charging  
wire as indicated, and hook the charging wire tension spring on the charging wire by the  
distance A ; then, twist it.  
A:  
• Primary charging assembly : 13.0 ± 0.5 mm  
• Transfer charging assembly : 12.0 ± 0.5 mm  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
A
Figure 10-214  
8) Cut the excess charging wire with a nipper.  
9) Pick the end of the charging wire tensioning spring with tweezers, and hook it on the  
charging electrode.  
Figure 10-215  
Note:  
Go through the following:  
• Be sure that the charging wire is free of bending and twisting, and its gold plating has  
not peeled.  
• Be sure that the charging wire is in the V-groove of the charging wire positioner.  
(correct)  
(wrong)  
Figure 10-216  
10) Wipe the charging wire with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol.  
Caution:  
• Do not use a cloth carrying metal powder for cleaning.  
• Do not use a moist cloth for cleaning.  
• Dry wipe with lint-free paper; then, mount only after making sure that alcohol has  
completely evaporated.  
11) Mount the sheet (front) and the sheet (rear).  
12) Mount the stopper and the grid plate.  
For the transfer charging assembly, mount the guide wire plate.  
10–12  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3. Adjusting the Height of the Charging Wires  
To adjust each charging wire, turn its respective height adjusting screw. A full turn on the  
screw will change the height of the primary charging wire by about 0.5 mm and that of the  
transfer charging wire by about 0.7 mm.  
Charging  
assembly  
Height of charging  
wire (mm)  
Range  
1.0mm  
11.0 0.2mm  
Primary  
Transfer  
1.0mm  
9.5 0.2mm  
Figure 10-217  
• Transfer Charging Assembly  
• Primary Charging Assembly  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Height adjusting  
screw  
Figure 10-218a  
Figure 10-218b  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
D. Pick-Up/Feeding System  
1. Adjusting the Pressure of the Separation Pad  
If double feeding or pick-up failure occurs, loosen the adjusting screw [1] and relocate the  
holder [2] to adjust the force of the separation pad tension spring.  
• If pick-up occurs, move the holder in the direction of [A].  
• If double feeding failure occurs, move the holder to in the direction of [B].  
[2]  
[A]  
[B]  
[1]  
Figure 10-219  
2. Changing the Cassette Size (AB/INCH)  
1) Slide out the cassette.  
2) Loosen the mounting screw [1] on the left side of the cassette; then, slide the size switching  
block [2] to the desired size position, and fix it in position.  
•AB  
[2] [1]  
[1]  
[2]  
•INCH  
Figure 10-220  
10–14  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3) Remove the mounting screw [3]; then, slide the size switching lever [4] to the desired size  
position, and fix it in place.  
•AB  
[4]  
[3]  
[4]  
[3]  
•INCH  
Figure 10-221  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
E. Fixing System  
1. Adjusting the Height of the Fixing Assembly Inlet Guide  
1) Loosen the two adjusting screws [1], and adjust the height of the fixing assembly inlet guides  
[2].  
[1]  
[1]  
[2]  
Figure 10-222  
2. Adjusting the Pressure of the Lower Roller (nip)  
If the nip is as indicated in Table 10-201, no adjustment is necessary.  
If the nip is not as indicated, change the position of the pressure spring [1].  
[1]  
[1]  
Figure 10-223  
10–16  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Caution:  
a and c represent points 10 mm from both ends of copy paper.  
c
Feeding  
direction  
b
Center of  
copy paper  
a
Figure 10-224  
Dimensions  
Measurements*  
b
4.8 ± 0.3mm  
I a - c I  
0.5 mm or less  
*Be sure both upper and lower rollers are  
sufficiently warm before taking measurements.  
Table 10-201  
a. Measuring the Nip  
Before measuring the nip, wait for 15 min after the end of warm-up and make 20 A4 copies:  
1) Set A3 copy paper.  
2) Open the copier cover.  
3) Execute nip measurement mode (service mode).  
The above steps will deliver a measurement sheet like the one shown in Figure 10-224.  
Note:  
When you execute nip measurement mode (service mode), the copy paper will stop half  
way through the delivery slot. It will then be discharged fully in about 15 sec.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
F. Electrical System  
1. Obtaining Optimum Exposure  
You can adjust the intensity of the scanning lamp (LA1) at F5 as follows (effective for both  
AE and manual):  
1) Set the setting of ‘U12’ (density correction) in user mode to its initial value.  
2) Place the Test Sheet (NA-3) on the copyboard, and select non-AE and Direct.  
3) Select ‘216’ (density adjusting volume voltage display) in service mode.  
4) Slide the density adjusting volume until the copy count indicator indicates ‘245’ as the F5  
voltage.  
5) Make a copy.  
6) Check the copy image, and change the setting of ‘326’ (scanning lamp on voltage  
adjustment) in service mode using the keypad.  
[1] A higher setting will increase the intensity, making the image lighter.  
[2] A lower setting will decrease the intensity, making the image darker.  
Intensity (manual)  
Intensity (AE)  
[1]  
[2]  
[1]  
[2]  
Copy  
density  
Copy  
density  
Original  
density  
1
5
9
Test Chart  
Figure 10-225  
7) Press the Start key, and store the setting.  
• Repeat steps 5) through 7) until an optimum image is obtained.  
8) Press the Reset key to end service mode.  
10–18  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
2. AE Adjustment  
If copies of a newspaper are foggy or if you have replaced the scanning lamp (LA1), AE  
sensor, or DC controller PCB, perform the following:  
(Be sure that the image is an optimum image before starting the work.)  
a. AE Auto Adjustment  
1. AE Scanning Intensity Auto Adjustment  
1) Select ‘301’ (AE auto adjustment) in service mode.  
2) Place the Test Chart (white background original) on the copyboard glass.  
3) Press ‘0’ of the keypad so that the copy count indicator indicates ‘0’.  
4) Press the Start key.  
• The scanner moves to the AE scan position, stops, and performs AE exposure. Then, the  
scanner moves in reverse to home position. (15 sec from start of forward movement and  
the end of reverse movement)  
• The output of the AE sensor will be indicated in the copy count indicator. Check to make  
sure it is 80 ±5. If not, execute ‘302’ (AE scanning intensity adjustment) in service mode.  
2. AE Slope Auto Adjustment  
5) Select ‘301’ (AE auto adjustment) in service mode.  
6) Place a newspaper on the copyboard glass.  
7) Press ‘1’ of the keyboard so that the copy count indicator indicates ‘1’.  
8) Press the Start key.  
• The scanner moves to the AE scan position, stops, and performs AE exposure. Then, the  
scanner moves in reverse to home position. (15 sec from start of forward movement and  
the end of reverse movement)  
• The output of the AE sensor will be indicated in the copy count indicator. Check to make  
sure it is between 0 and 255. If not, execute ‘303’ (AE slope adjustment) in service mode.  
9) Press the Reset key to end service mode.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
b. AE Scanning Intensity Adjustment  
If an optimum image cannot be obtained by executing ‘301’ (AE auto adjustment) in service  
mode, perform the following:  
1) Place a white background original on the copyboard glass, and select AE and Direct.  
2) Make a copy, and check the copy image.  
3) Select ‘302’ (AE scanning intensity adjustment) in service mode.  
• The copy count indicator will indicate the present setting.  
4) Change the setting using the keypad or the +/- key.  
[1] A higher setting will increase the intensity, making the copy image lighter.  
[2] A lower setting will decrease the intensity, making the copy image darker.  
[1]  
Intensity  
[2]  
Copy  
density  
Original  
density  
Test Chart  
Figure 10-226  
5) Press the Start key to store the new setting.  
• Repeat steps 2) through 5) until an optimum image is obtained.  
6) Press the Reset key to end service mode.  
10–20  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
c. AE Slope Adjustment  
If an optimum image cannot be obtained by executing ‘301’ (AE auto adjustment) in service  
mode, perform the following:  
1) Place a newspaper on the copyboard glass, and select AE and Direct.  
2) Make a copy, and check the copy image.  
3) Select ‘303’ (AE slope adjustment) in service mode.  
• The copy counter will indicate the present setting.  
4) Change the setting using the keypad or +/- key.  
[1] A higher setting will increase the intensity, making the copy image lighter.  
[2] A lower setting will decrease the intensity, making the copy image darker.  
Intensity (AE)  
[1]  
[2]  
Copy  
image  
Original  
density  
Test  
Chart  
Newspaper  
Figure 10-227  
5) Press the Start key to store the new setting.  
• Repeat steps 2) through 5) until an optimum image is obtained.  
6) Press the Reset key to end service mode.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3. After Replacing the DC Controller PCB  
1) Set the DIP switch (SW102) on the new DC controller PCB so that its settings are the same  
as the old DC controller PCB.  
2) Mount the new DC controller PCB.  
3) Press the User Mode key, hold down ‘2’ and ‘8’ of the numeric keypad for 0.5 sec or more,  
and then press the User Mode key.  
• The copier starts service mode, and indicates ‘[1]’ on the control panel.  
4) Press ‘4’ on the numeric keypad, and press the AE key.  
• The copier enters FUNCTION mode, and indicates ‘401’ on the control panel.  
5) Press ‘5’ and ‘0’ on the numeric keypad in sequence, and press the Start key.  
• The copier turns off once, and initializes the RAM (IC116).  
6) Press ‘1’ of the keypad and the Start key in sequence.  
• The power turns off, and the data in RAM (IC116) will be initialized.  
7) Enter the settings of each service mode by referring to the service mode label kept behind the  
front door.  
8) Press the Reset key to end service mode.  
10–22  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
4. Checking the Photointerrupters  
The copier allows you to use its service mode when checking its photointerrupters. (You may  
also use a conventional meter.)  
a. Using a Meter  
1) Put the copier in standby state.  
2) Set the range of the meter to 30 VDC.  
3) Connect the - probe of the meter to J105-5 (GND) of the DC controller PCB.  
4) Connect the + probe of the meter to the appropriate terminal on the DC controller PCB  
indicated in the tables that follow.  
5) Make checks as instructed.  
b. Using Service Mode  
1) Press the User Mode key.  
2) Press ‘2’ and ‘8’ of the keypad at the same time. (Hold them down for 0.5 sec or more.)  
3) Press the User Mode key once again.  
• The copier starts service mode, and indicates ‘1’ on the copy count indicator.  
4) Press ‘2’ and then the AE in sequence.  
• The copier starts I/O DISPLAY mode, and indicates ‘201’.  
5) Enter the appropriate service mode No. indicated in the tables that follow, and press the Start  
key.  
6) Make checks as instructed.  
• Refer to the state of the copy count indicator LEDs. (Tables use ‘1’ to indicate ON, and ‘0’  
to indicate OFF.)  
2a  
1a  
2b  
1f  
1b  
1g  
2c  
1e  
1c  
2d  
1d  
Figure 10-228  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Connector  
Sensor  
Checks  
LED  
Voltage  
Service mode  
In standby,  
move the  
scanner by  
hand.  
PS1  
Scanner home  
position sensor 220  
J103-B2  
1a=1  
1a=0  
1c=1  
1c=0  
1b=1  
1b=0  
1b=1  
1b=0  
1g=1  
1g=0  
1f=1  
1f=0  
2b=1  
2b=0  
1f=1  
1f=0  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS1,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS1,  
PS2  
Lens home  
position sensor 219  
J103-B5  
In standby,  
move the lens  
by hand.  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS2,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS2,  
In standby,  
move the  
No. 4/No. 5  
mirror by hand.  
PS3  
J103-B8  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS3,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS3,  
When the light-blocking plate is PS4,  
Mirror home  
position sensor 219  
In standby,  
move the  
detecting lever  
by hand.  
PS4  
Cassette  
paper sensor  
J107-B12  
202  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS4,  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS5,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS5,  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS6,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS6,  
In standby,  
move the  
detecting lever  
by hand.  
PS5  
Registration  
paper sensor  
J107-A2  
222  
In standby,  
move the  
detecting lever  
by hand.  
PS6  
Delivery  
paper sensor  
J124-2  
222  
In standby,  
move the  
detection lever  
by hand.  
PS7  
Multi paper  
sensor  
J107-A8  
202  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS7,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS7,  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS8,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS8,  
PS8  
J106-10  
223  
In standby,  
move the  
detecting lever  
by hand.  
Waste toner  
feeding screw  
locked sensor  
In standby,  
move the slide  
guide by hand.  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS9,  
PS9  
Multi wide  
sensor 1  
J107-A11  
202  
2c=1  
2c=0  
2d=1  
2d=0  
1d=1  
1d=0  
1a=1  
1a=0  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
5V  
0V  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS9,  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS10,  
In standby,  
move the slide  
guide by hand.  
PS10  
Multi wide  
sensor 2  
J107-A14  
202  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS10,  
When the light-blocking plate is at PS11,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at PS11,  
When the light-blocking plate is at sensor,  
When the light-blocking plate is not at sensor,  
In standby,  
open the right  
door.  
PS11  
Right door  
open sensor  
J107-B7  
202  
In standby,  
remove the  
waste toner  
box.  
Waste toner  
sensor  
J106-9  
222  
10–24  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
III. IMAGE FAULTS  
A. Initial Checks  
1. Checking the Site Environment  
a. The power outlet must be exclusive, and must provide the rated voltage. (The power plug  
must remain connected throughout day and night.)  
b. The copier must not be installed in a high-temperature/-humidity environment (near a water  
faucet, water boiler, humidifier), near a source of fire, or in a dusty area.  
c. The copier must not be subjected to ammonium gas.  
d. The copier must be kept away from direct sunshine. As necessary, provide curtains.  
e. The site must be well ventilated.  
f. The copier must be kept level.  
g. The copier must remain powered throughout day and night.  
Check to make sure that all above conditions are met.  
2. Checking the Originals  
Identify the problem as to its cause—original page or the copier.  
a. As a rule, the Copy Density adjusting lever must be at the median graduations, and ‘U12:  
density correction’ in user mode must be set to ‘0’.  
b. Original pages with a reddish background can cause poor contrast.  
EX. Slips (invoices) made on reddish paper.  
c. Diazo copies and original pages with a high transparency can produce copies mistakenly  
identified as “foggy” copies. Original pages prepared in light pencil, on the other hand, can  
produce copies mistakenly identified as “light” copies.  
3. Checking the Copyboard Cover and Copyboard Glass  
If soiled, clean it using a solution of mild detergent or alcohol. If scratches are found, replace it.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
4. Checking the Charging Assembly  
a. Check each charging assembly for soiling and a fault on its charging wire (scratches).  
b. Clean the charging wire and shield plate of each charging assembly. (If dirt cannot be  
removed, replace it.)  
c. Check the height of each charging wire.  
d. Check to make sure that each charging wire is not rusted.  
f. Check to make sure that the anti-vibration rubber (of each charging assembly) is not  
displaced.  
5. Checking the Developing Assembly  
a. Check to make sure that the rollers on both ends of the developing assembly are in contact  
with the drum.  
b. Check to make sure that the surface of the developing cylinder is coated with an even layer of  
toner.  
6. Checking the Paper  
a. Check if the paper is of a type recommended by Canon.  
b. Check if the paper is not moist.  
Try using paper fresh out of package.  
7. Checking the Periodically Replaced Parts  
Replace those parts that have reached their service life as indicated in the Scheduled  
Servicing Chart and the Periodically Replaced Parts Table.  
8. Others  
Keep in mind that bringing in a copier from a cold to warm room, as during installation in  
winter, can cause condensation in its inside, causing various problems.  
a. Condensation on the scanning system (glass, mirror, lens, etc.) can cause light images.  
b. Condensation in the charging system can cause electric leakage.  
c. Condensation on the pick-up/feeding guide plate can cause faulty feeding.  
If condensation is noted, dry wipe the part or leave the copier powered for about one hour.  
Caution:  
If a discrepancy in density (between separation side and rear), light image, of fogging  
occurs, try to correct the problem by following the “Image Adjustment Basic Procedure.”  
10–26  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
B. Image Fault Samples  
not available  
10–28  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
C. Troubleshooting Image Faults  
1. The copy is too light. (halftone area only)  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
YES  
Actions  
Perform the Image Adjustment Basic  
Procedure. Is the problem corrected?  
End.  
End.  
Scanner  
2
3
Clean the mirror, lens, and dust-  
proofing glass. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES  
NO  
NO  
Developing  
assembly  
Are the rollers of the developing  
assembly in firm contact with the  
drum during copying operation?  
Check the developing assembly  
locking lever.  
Developing  
assembly  
4
5
Is the coating of toner on the  
developing cylinder even?  
Check the developing assembly.  
Lamp regulator PCB  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the lamp regulator PCB. Is  
the problem corrected?  
YES  
NO  
End.  
Replace the DC controller PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
2. The copy is too light. (including solid black area)  
3. The copy is too light. (entirely, considerably)  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
YES  
Actions  
End.  
Perform the Image Adjustment Basic  
Procedure. Is the problem corrected?  
2
3
Go to step 7.  
Turn off the power switch in the  
middle of copying operation. Then,  
open the front door, and open the top  
unit. Is the toner image on the  
photosensitive drum before transfer  
more or less normal?  
NO  
NO  
Transfer  
charging  
assembly  
1.Hook the charging wire correctly.  
2.Adjust the height of the charging  
wire.  
Is the charging wire of the transfer  
charging assembly hooked correctly?  
Are its height and position normal?  
4
5
1.Clean the charging wire.  
2.Set the charging assembly securely.  
Is the transfer charging assembly set  
securely?  
NO  
Copy paper  
1.The paper may be moist. Instruct  
the user on the correct method of  
storing copy paper.  
Try paper fresh out of package. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES  
2.Inform the user that the use of  
paper of a type not recommended  
by Canon may not always bring  
about good results.  
Lower transfer  
guide/varistor  
6
1.Check to make sure that the  
transfer guide is not in contact with  
the metal area of the feeding  
assembly (e.g., side plate).  
2.Replace the varistor.  
Measure the resistance between the  
lower transfer guide and the metal  
portion of the feeding assembly. Is it  
0 ?  
YES  
NO  
NO  
NO  
High-voltage  
cord, DC  
controller PCB  
1.Check the continuity of the high-  
voltage cord.  
2.Check the high-voltage power  
supply (primary/transfer) and the  
DC controller PCB.  
Developing  
assembly  
7
Check the developing assembly  
locking lever.  
Is the developing assembly set  
securely? Are the rolls of the  
developing assembly firmly in  
contact with the photosensitive drum?  
Toner sensor  
(TS1)  
8
9
Check the tone sensor. Then, supply  
toner.  
Is toner in the developing assembly?  
Photosensitive  
drum  
End.  
Replace the drum unit. Is the problem YES  
corrected?  
Developing  
bias control  
Check the control system of the  
developing bias.  
NO  
10–30  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
4. The copy has uneven density. (front side dark)  
5. The copy has uneven density. (front side light)  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
YES End.  
Actions  
Perform the Image Adjustment Basic  
Procedure. Is the problem corrected?  
Developing  
assembly  
2
3
Are the developing rolls of the  
developing assembly in firm contact  
with the photosensitive drum?  
NO Check the developing assembly  
locking lever.  
Scanner  
Clean the scanning lamp, reflecting  
plate, side reflecting plate, mirror,  
lens, and dust-proofing glass. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Pre-scanning lamp  
(LA2)  
4
5
Does the pre-exposure lamp remain  
on during copying?  
NO  
NO  
1.Replace the pre-exposure lamp.  
2.Replace the DC controller PCB.  
Developing  
assembly  
Is the developing cylinder coated  
with a uniform layer of toner?  
1.Clean the tip of the blade of the  
developing assembly. (dry wiping)?  
2.Clean the surface of the developing  
cylinder.  
3.Check to make sure that the toner  
inside the developing assembly is  
not displaced to one side.  
Charging assembly,  
Copy paper  
YES  
1.Clean all charging wires once  
again, and check the height of the  
charging wires once again.  
2.Try replacing the copy paper.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
6. The copy is foggy. (overall)  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
Actions  
Perform the Image Adjustment Basic  
Procedure. Is the problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Scanner  
2
3
Clean the scanning lamp, reflecting  
plate, side reflecting plate, mirror,  
lens, and dust-proofing glass. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Pre-exposure lamp  
(LA2),  
Does the pre-exposure lamp remain  
on during copying?  
NO  
1.Replace the pre-exposure lamp.  
2.Replace the DC controller PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
Developing roll  
4
5
6
Are the developing rolls worn?  
Is the developing cylinder worn?  
YES Replace the developing rolls.  
YES Replace the developing cylinder.  
YES End.  
Developing cylinder  
Scanner lamp (LA1)  
Replace the scanning lamp. Is the  
problem corrected?  
High-voltage power  
supply PCB  
7
8
Replace the high-voltage power  
supply PCB. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
YES End.  
Lamp regulator PCB  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the lamp regulator PCB. Is  
the problem corrected?  
NO  
Replace the DC controller PCB.  
10–32  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
7. The copy is foggy. (vertical)  
8. The copy has black lines. (vertical, fuzzy, thick)  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
Actions  
Primary charging  
assembly  
Clean the primary charging wire, grid  
plate, and shielding plate. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Scanner  
2
Clean the scanning lamp, reflecting  
plate, side reflecting plate, mirror,  
lens, and dust-proofing glass. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
YES End.  
Pre-exposure lamp  
(LA2)  
3
4
Clean the pre-exposure lamp. Is the  
problem corrected?  
Developing  
assembly  
Is the developing cylinder coated  
with a uniform layer of toner?  
NO  
Check and clean the edge of the blade  
of the developing assembly.  
Fixing assembly  
YES Check the fixing assembly.  
9. The copy has black lines. (vertical, thin)  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
NO  
Actions  
Press the Copy Start key, and turn off  
the power switch while the copy  
paper is in the feeding assembly. At  
this time, does the copy image before  
it goes through the fixing assembly  
have black lines?  
Go to step 4.  
Transfer guide  
2
3
Is the transfer guide soiled  
(particularly the transfer upper guide)?  
YES Clean the transfer guide.  
Photosensitive drum  
Are there scratches or black lines in  
the peripheral direction of the surface  
of the photosensitive drum?  
YES Replace the drum unit. If scratches  
are found, be sure to find out the  
cause.  
Developing system,  
Exposure system  
NO  
YES  
NO  
Check the developing system and the  
exposure system.  
Fixing assembly  
4
Are there scratches or black lines in  
the peripheral direction of the surface  
of the fixing upper roller?  
1.Replace the upper roller.  
2.Check the separation claw.  
Check to make sure that the fixing  
assembly inlet is not soiled.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
10.The copy has white spots. (vertical)  
11.The copy has white lines. (vertical)  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Fixing assembly  
Press the Copy Start key with the  
copyboard cover open, and turn off  
the power switch while the copy  
paper is moving through the feeding  
assembly. At this time, does the copy  
image before it goes through the  
fixing assembly have white spots or  
lines?  
1.Clean the fixing assembly inlet  
guide.  
2.Check the upper fixing roller.  
3.Clean the separation claw.  
Primary charging  
assembly  
2
Clean the primary charging wire, grid  
plate, and shield plate. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES Clean the part thoroughly with  
alcohol. If the dirt cannot be removed,  
remove the charging wire.  
Developing  
assembly  
3
4
Is the developing cylinder coated with  
an even layer of toner?  
NO Check the edge of the blade of the  
developing assembly for paper 1int.  
Copy paper  
Try copy paper fresh out of package.  
Is the problem corrected?  
YES The copy paper is moist. Instruct the  
user on the correct method of storing  
copy paper.  
Photosensitive drum  
5
6
Are there scratches in the peripheral  
direction corresponding to the  
developing image?  
YES Replace the drum unit. If scratches are  
found, be sure to identify the cause.  
Blank exposure  
lamp (LA3),  
DC controller PCB  
Is the blank exposure lamp LED  
corresponding to the white spot or line  
on the copy on while the scanner is  
moving forward?  
YES Check the wiring from the blank  
exposure lamp to the DC controller  
PCB: if normal, replace the DC  
controller PCB.  
External light  
NO Check to make sure that the  
photosensitive drum is free of external  
light.  
Transfer charging  
assembly  
7
8
Clean the transfer charging wire and  
the shield plate. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
Separation static  
eliminator  
Clean the separation static eliminator.  
Is the problem corrected?  
YES End.  
10–34  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
12.The copy has white spots. (vertical)  
Yes/No  
YES  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Developing  
assembly  
Is the problem noted at intervals of  
about 3.2 cm? (scratch on the  
developing cylinder)  
1.Clean the developing roller.  
2.Clean the surface of the developing  
cylinder.  
3.If scratches are found on the  
surface of the developing cylinder,  
replace the developing cylinder or  
the developing assembly.  
Photosensitive drum  
Copy paper  
2
Is the problem noted at intervals of  
about 9.4 cm? (scratch on the  
photosensitive drum)  
YES  
1.Clean the photosensitive drum.  
2.If the scratches are found on the  
photosensitive drum, replace the  
drum unit.  
3
4
Try copy paper fresh out of package.  
Is the problem corrected?  
YES  
YES  
The copy paper is moist. Instruct the  
user on the correct method of storing  
copy paper.  
Scanner rail,  
Scanner cable  
Is the problem noted at the same  
location on all copies?  
1.Check the scanner rail for a foreign  
object.  
2.Adjust the tension of the scanner  
cable.  
Charging wire  
NO  
Clean each charging wire.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
13.The back of the copy is soiled.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Go to step 3.  
Turn off the power switch while the  
copy paper is moving through the  
feeding assembly. At this time, is the  
back of the copy paper soiled?  
1.Clean the registration roller.  
2.Clean the transfer guide.  
3.Check the developing assembly for  
leakage of toner.  
Developing  
assembly  
2
Is the problem noted at intervals of  
about 5 cm?  
YES  
1.Clean the feeding assembly.  
2.Check the drum cleaner assembly  
for leakage of toner.  
Drum cleaner  
assembly  
NO  
1.Clean the fixing roller (upper,  
lower).  
Fixing assembly  
3
Is the fixing roller (upper, lower)  
soiled with toner?  
YES  
2.Check to make sure that the toner  
adhering to the heat discharging  
roller is not soiling the fixing  
roller.  
If so, replace the heat discharging  
roller.  
3.Clean the fixing assembly inlet  
guide.  
Clean the delivery roller and the  
separation claw.  
Delivery assembly  
NO  
10–36  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
14.The copy has faulty fixing.  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Fixing roller (upper/  
lower)  
Is the problem noted vertically?  
YES Check the fixing roller (upper, lower)  
for scratches.  
Fixing heater (H1)  
2
3
Does the fixing heater (H1) turn on  
immediately after power-on?  
NO  
NO  
See the “Fixing heater fails to turn  
on.”  
Fixing lower heater  
pressure  
Is the nip of the fixing assembly as  
indicated?  
Adjust the fixing lower roller  
pressure.  
Copy paper  
YES Try recommended paper. If the results  
are good, advise the user to use  
recommended paper.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
15.  
16.The copy has a displaced leading edge.  
17.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Original page  
Is the original page placed correctly?  
Place the original page correctly.  
Copy paper  
2
Is the paper of a type recommended  
by Canon?  
NO  
Try recommended paper. If the results  
are good, advise the user to use  
recommended paper.  
3
Make copies using the cassette and the  
multifeeder tray? Is the displacement on  
the leading edge the same regardless of  
the source of paper?  
YES If the results are the same, go to step 4.  
NO Check each pick-up system.  
Pick-up roller  
4
5
6
Has the pick-up roller reached its  
life?  
YES If wear is noted on the pick-up roller,  
replace it.  
Leading edge  
margin  
Adjust the leading edge margin. Is  
the problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Registration clutch  
(CL1), Registration  
roller  
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and  
measure the voltage between J211-7  
(+) and J211-6 (-) on the power  
supply PCB. Does it change from 0  
to 24 V while the scanner is moving  
forward?  
YES  
NO  
1.Replace the registration clutch.  
2.Check the registration roller for  
deformation and wear.  
DC controller PCB  
Check the wiring from J106 on the  
DC controller PCB to CL1; if normal,  
replace the DC controller PCB.  
10–38  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
18.The copy has a blurred image.  
Yes/No  
YES  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Scanner cable  
Does the cable wind on the cable  
pulley in layers while the scanner is  
moving?  
1.Route the cable once again.  
2.If the cable is twisted or frayed,  
replace it.  
Scanner rail  
2
3
Move the No. 1 mirror mount slowly  
by hand. Does it move smoothly?  
NO  
Clean the surface of the scanner rail  
with alcohol. Then, apply a small  
amount of lubricant.  
Photosensitive drum  
Is the problem noted at intervals of  
about 9.4 cm?  
YES  
1.Check the drum gear.  
2.Check the end of the drum (in  
contact with the developing roller)  
for scratches and protrusions.  
Developing gear  
4
Is the problem noted at intervals of  
about 3.2 cm?  
YES  
NO  
Check the developing assembly.  
Check the drum drive system.  
Drum drive system  
19.The copy is foggy. (horizontally)  
Yes/No  
YES  
Step  
1
Cause  
Checks  
Actions  
Is the problem noted at the same  
Go to step 4.  
location on all copies made in Direct?  
2
3
Scanning lamp  
(LA1), Lamp  
regulator PCB  
Does the scanning lamp flicker when  
the scanner is moving forward?  
Check the scanning lamp and the  
lamp regulator PCB.  
YES  
YES  
Developing roller  
Is the developing roller soiled with  
toner, is the roller deformed, or is the  
area in contact with the developing  
roller (photosensitive drum) soiled  
with toner?  
Clean or, if necessary, replace the  
developing roller.  
4
5
Developing bias  
Is the developing bias applied  
correctly?  
Remove the developing assembly,  
and check the wiring; then, set it once  
again.  
NO  
Scanner  
Make a copy in Reduce, and compare  
it with a copy made in Direct. Is the  
problem noted in a different location?  
Check the scanning system.  
Check the feeding assembly.  
YES  
NO  
Feeding assembly  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
20.The copy has poor sharpness.  
Yes/No  
YES Clean the copyboard glass.  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Copyboard glass  
Is the copyboard glass soiled with oil  
or the like?  
Mirror  
2
3
Is the horizontal reproduction ratio in  
Direct as indicated?  
NO  
Adjust the distance between the No. 1  
mirror and the No. 2 mirror.  
Scanner  
Clean the scanning lamp, reflecting  
plate, mirror, lens, and dust-proofing  
glass. Is the problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Lens drive assembly,  
No. 4/No. 5 mirror  
drive assembly  
4
Is there dirt or foreign object in the  
path of the lens and the No. 4/ No. 5  
mirror? Does the part, when pushed  
by hand, move smoothly?  
YES Remove the dirt and foreign object.  
As necessary, clean and lubricate.  
Photosensitive drum  
NO  
Replace the drum unit.  
10–40  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
21.The copy is blank.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Drum unit  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Is the drum unit set securely?  
Remove and set the drum unit once  
again.  
Developing  
assembly  
2
3
4
5
Is the developing assembly set  
securely?  
NO  
Remove and set the developing  
assembly securely.  
Primary charging  
assembly  
Is the primary charging wire broken?  
YES Spring the charging wire.  
Developing  
assembly  
Is the developing assembly locked to  
the drum?  
NO  
NO  
Check the developing assembly  
locking lever.  
DC controller PCB  
Does the blank exposure lamp remain  
off while the scanner is moving  
forward?  
Check the DC controller PCB.  
Scanning lamp  
(LA1)  
6
7
8
Does the scanning lamp remain on  
during copying operation?  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Make checks as instructed under “The  
scanning lamp fails to turn on.”  
Connector  
Are the connectors on each PCB  
connected securely?  
Connect the connectors securely.  
Replace the high-voltage cord.  
High-voltage cord  
Is there continuity between high-  
voltage cords connected to each  
charging assembly?  
High-voltage power  
supply (primary/  
transfer)  
YES Check the high-voltage power supply  
(primary/transfer).  
22.The copy is solid black.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Does the scanning lamp remain on  
during copying operation?  
Make checks according to the  
instructions under “The scanning  
lamp fails to turns off.”  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
IV. TROUBLESHOOTING MALFUNCTIONS  
A. Copier  
1. E000  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Execute service mode ‘412’ (error clear) to  
clear E000. Open the front door and the top  
unit, and let the fixing roller cool sufficiently.  
Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
and then connect the power plug.  
See “The Fixing heater fails to  
turn on.”  
Turn on the power switch. Does the fixing  
heater turn on?  
Caution:  
Do not repeat the steps without cooling  
the fixing roller sufficiently, or abnormal  
increase in the fixing temperature will  
damage the fixing roller and the  
separation claw.  
Turn off the power switch, and let the fixing  
roller cool sufficiently. Turn on the power  
switch, and select service mode ‘109’ (fixing  
main thermistor detection temperature  
display). Does the reading remain unchanged  
at ‘109’?  
Check the wiring on the DC  
controller PCB to the  
thermistor; if normal, replace  
the thermistor.  
Main thermistor  
(TH1)  
2
YES  
(After the check, be sure to turn off the  
power switch.)  
Turn off the power switch, and let the fixing  
roller cool sufficiently. Turn on the power  
switch, and select service mode ‘110’ (fixing  
sub thermistor detection temperature  
display). Does the reading remain unchanged  
at ‘110’?  
Check the wiring from J109  
on the DC controller PCB to  
the thermistor; if normal,  
replace the thermistor.  
Sub thermistor  
(TH2)  
3
YES  
(After the check, be sure to tun off the power  
switch.)  
Is the thermistor in even contact with the  
upper fixing assembly?  
Mount the thermistor  
correctly.  
Thermistor (TH1,  
TH2)  
4
5
6
NO  
YES  
NO  
Clean the area of contact of the thermistor. Is  
the problem corrected?  
End.  
Thermistor (TH1,  
TH2)  
Is the operating environment as specified?  
• Inform the user that the  
operating environment  
does not meet the  
Operating  
environment  
requirements.  
• Instruct the user not to turn  
on the copier before the  
room is warm enough.  
Replace the DC controller.  
DC controller PCB  
YES  
10–42  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
2. E001  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Go to step 3.  
Step  
1
Checks  
Execute service mode ‘412’ (error clear) to  
clear E001. Open the front door and the top  
unit, and let the fixing roller cool  
sufficiently.  
Turn on the power switch. Is E001 indicated  
immediately after power-on?  
Replace the thermistor.  
Thermistor (TH1,  
TH2)  
2
3
Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
J108 and J109 on the DC controller PCB.  
Connect the probes to J108-2 and J108-3  
and then J109-1 and J109-2 on the harness  
side. Is the resistance about 0 ? (After the  
check, be sure to connect J108 and J109.)  
YES  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
End.  
Triac  
Replace the power supply PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES  
NO  
Check the wiring from the  
power supply PCB to the DC  
controller PCB; if normal,  
replace the DC controller PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
3. E002/E003  
Yes/No  
YES  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Execute service mode ‘412’ (error clear) to  
clear E002 or E003. Open the front door and  
the top unit, and let the fixing roller cool  
sufficiently.  
See the appropriate section.  
Turn on the power switch. Does any of the  
following apply?  
• The fixing heater fails to turn on.  
• E000  
YES  
Main thermistor  
2
Turn off the power switch, and let the fixing  
roller cool sufficiently. Turn on the power  
switch, and select service mode ‘109’.  
(fixing main thermistor detection  
temperature display)  
Check the wiring from J108  
on the DC controller PCB to  
the thermistor; if normal,  
replace the thermistor.  
Does the reading remain unchanged at  
‘109’? (After the check, be sure to turn off  
the power switch.)  
YES  
Sub thermistor  
(TH2)  
3
Check the wiring from J109  
on the DC controller PCB to  
the thermistor; if normal,  
replace the thermistor.  
Turn off the power switch, and let the fixing  
roller cool sufficiently. Turn on the power  
switch, and select service mode ‘110’.  
(fixing sub thermistor temperature display)  
Does the reading remain unchanged at  
‘110’? (After the check, be sure to turn off  
the power switch.)  
NO  
YES  
NO  
Thermistor  
(TH1, TH2)  
4
5
6
Is the thermistor in even contact with the  
upper fixing roller?  
Mount the thermistor  
correctly.  
Thermistor  
(TH1, TH2)  
End.  
Clean the area of contact of the thermistor. Is  
the problem corrected?  
Operating  
environment  
Is the operating environment as indicated?  
• Inform the user that the  
operating environment  
does not meet the  
requirements.  
• Instruct the user not to turn  
on the copier before the  
room is warm enough.  
YES  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
10–44  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
4. E004  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Fixing heater (H1)  
Execute service mode ‘412’ (error clear) to  
clear E004.  
See “The fixing heater fails to  
turn on.”  
Turn on the power switch. Does the fixing  
heater turn on?  
Triac  
2
Replace the power supply PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Check the wiring from the  
power supply PCB to the DC  
controller PCB; if normal,  
replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
5. E010  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Connector  
Are all connectors of the main motor (M1)  
connected?  
NO Connect the connectors.  
Power supply PCB  
2
3
Turn on the power switch. Set the meter  
range to 30 VDC, and connect the probes to  
J209-4 (+) and J209-3 (-) on the DC  
NO See “DC power is absent.”  
controller PCB. Is the voltage about 24 V?  
Main motor (M1)  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the main motor. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
NO Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
6. E013  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Waste toner feeding  
screw  
Is the flag of the waste toner feeding screw  
locked sensor rotating when the main motor  
is rotating?  
Remove the drum unit, and  
turn the feeding screw by  
hand. If it rotates easily, check  
how it is mounted. If it does  
not turn, replace the drum unit,  
and remove the cause.  
Waste toner feeding  
screw locked sensor  
(PS8)  
2
Is the waste toner feeding screw locked  
sensor normal? (See the instructions on how  
to check the photointerrupters.)  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to PS8; if  
normal, replace PS8.  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
7. E030  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Total copy counter  
(CNT1)  
Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
J102 from the DC controller PCB. Set the  
meter range to 1 K, and connect the probes  
to J102-A11 and J102-A10. Is the resistance  
about 500 ?  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the counter;  
if normal, replace the counter.  
Total copy counter  
(CNT1)  
2
Connect J102 to the DC controller PCB, and  
turn on the power switch. Set the meter range  
to 30 VCD, and connect the probes J102-  
A11 (+) and J102-A10 (-) on the DC  
controller PCB. Does the voltage change  
from about 0 to about 24 and then to about 0  
V when the Start key is pressed?  
YES Replace the counter.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
10–46  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
8. E031  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Accessory counter  
(CNT2)  
Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
J102 from the DC controller PCB. Set the  
meter range to 1 K, and connect the probes  
to J102-A13 and J102-A12. Is the resistance  
about 500 ?  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the counter;  
if normal, replace the counter.  
Accessory counter  
(CNT2)  
2
Connect J102 to the DC controller PCB, and  
turn on the power switch. Set the meter range  
to 30 VDC, and connect the probes to  
J102A13 (+) and J102-A12 (-) on the DC  
controller PCB. Does the voltage change  
from about 0 to about 24 and then to about  
0 V when the Start key is pressed?  
YES Replace the counter.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
9. E202 (The keys on the control panel fail to operate.)  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Does the scanner move forward or in reverse  
until E202 is detected?  
See “The scanner fails to  
move.”  
Scanner home  
position sensor  
(PS1)  
2
Is the scanner home position sensor normal?  
(See the instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupters.)  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the sensor;  
if normal, replace the sensor.  
NO  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
YES  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
10.E208  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Does the mirror move when the power  
switch is turned on?  
See “The mirror fails to  
move.”  
Mirror home  
position sensor  
(PS3)  
2
Is the mirror home position sensor normal?  
(See the instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupters.)  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the sensor;  
if normal, replace the sensor.  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
11.E210  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Turn on the power switch. Does the lens  
move?  
See “The lens fails to move.”  
Lens home position  
sensor (PS2)  
2
Is the lens home position sensor normal?  
(See the instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupters.)  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the sensor;  
if normal, replace the sensor.  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
10–48  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
12.E220  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Does the scanning lamp (LA1) remain off?  
YES See “The scanning lamp fails  
to turn on.”  
Lamp regulator PCB  
2
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the probes to J211-2 (+) and J211-1 (-) on  
the DC controller PCB. Is the voltage  
between the terminals when the scanning  
lamp turn on about 5 V?  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the lamp  
regulator PCB; if normal,  
replace the lamp regulator  
PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
13.E261  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Power supply PCB  
Replace the power supply PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Power supply  
frequency  
NO  
If E261 is indicated often,  
advise the user to install a  
frequency stabilizer.  
14.E710/E711  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Malfunction  
Turn off and then on the power switch. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
15.E712  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Malfunction  
Turn off and then on the power switch. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Connector  
2
3
Is the connector (J754) used between the  
ADF and the copier connected securely?  
NO  
Connect the connector  
securely.  
ADF PCB  
Replace the ADF controller PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
16.E717  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Malfunction  
Turn off and then on the power switch. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Connector  
2
3
Is the connector (J722) used between the  
Remote Diagnostic Device II and the copier  
connected securely?  
NO  
Connect the connector  
securely.  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the DC controller PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Remote Diagnostic  
Device II  
NO  
See the Service Manual of the  
Remote Diagnostic Device II.  
10–50  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
17.E800  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Malfunction  
Turn off and then on the power switch. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Power supply PCB  
DC controller PCB  
2
Replace the power supply PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
NO  
Check the wiring and  
continuity from the DC  
controller PCB to the control  
panel PCB; if normal, replace  
the DC controller PCB.  
18.E805  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Check service mode '106' (E805 details)  
while 'E805' is being indicated.  
Make the checks in step 2 and  
later to identify the fan that  
caused the error.  
Connector  
2
3
Are the connectors from the connector on the  
DC controller PCB to the exhaust fan proper?  
Connect the connectors.  
Exhaust fan  
(FM2, FM4, FM5)  
Replace the exhaust fan. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the exhaust  
fan; if normal, replace the DC  
controller PCB.  
19.E821  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Ozone filter  
Replace the ozone filter. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
Cleaner thermistor  
(TH3)  
2
Turn on the power switch, and select service  
mode 111 (clean thermistor detection  
temperature).  
YES Check the wiring from J112  
on the DC controller PCB to  
the thermistor; if normal,  
Do the reading remain as ‘111’?  
replace the thermistor.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
20.AC power is absent.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Power cord  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Is the power cord connected to the copier?  
Connect the cord.  
Power plug  
2
3
Is the power plug connected to the power  
outlet?  
NO  
NO  
Connect the power plug.  
Main power supply  
Is the rated AC voltage present at the power  
outlet?  
This is not the copier’s  
problem. Inform the user  
accordingly.  
Front door  
4
5
Is the front door closed securely?  
NO  
Close the front door.  
Is the rated voltage present between J204-1  
and J204-3 on the DC controller PCB?  
YES End.  
YES End.  
YES End.  
Circuit breaker  
(CB1, CB2)  
6
7
Press the button on the circuit breaker (CB1,  
CB2). Is AC power supplied?  
Power cord  
Replace the power supply cord. Is AC power  
supplied?  
NO  
Check the wiring of the AC  
power line. Check the  
connector for contact.  
Fuse  
8
9
Is the fuse (FU1, FU2) on the DC power  
supply PCB blown? (125 V, 5 A for 120 V  
model; 250 V, 2 A for 230 V model)  
YES Remove the cause, and replace  
the fuse.  
Power supply PCB  
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the meter probes to J105-4(+) and J105-5(-)  
on the DC controller PCB. Is the voltage  
reading about 5 V?  
NO  
Check the wiring from J105  
on the DC controller PCB to  
the power supply PCB; if  
normal, replace the power  
supply PCB.  
Wiring  
10 Is there continuity between J101-B15 on the  
DC controller PCB and J403-1 on the DC  
controller PCB?  
NO  
NO  
Check the wiring.  
11 Is there continuity between J212-1 on the  
DC power supply PCB and J106-2 on the  
DC controller PCB?  
Check the wiring.  
Control panel PCB  
DC controller PCB  
12 Replace the control panel PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
NO  
Replace the DC power supply  
PCB.  
10–52  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
21.DC power supply is absent.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
AC power supply  
Is the rated voltage present between J204-1  
and J204-3 on the DC power supply PCB?  
See “AC power is absent.”  
Fuse (power supply  
PCB)  
2
3
Is the fuse (FU1, FU2, FU3, FU4, FU5) on  
the power supply blown?  
YES Remove the cause, and replace  
the fuse.  
Wiring, DC load  
Turn off the power switch, and disconnect  
the power plug. Disconnect J208, J209, J210  
on the power supply PCB. Connect the  
power plug, and turn on the power switch. At  
this time, is the voltage between the  
following terminals normal?  
YES Check the wiring and the  
connectors of the DC power  
supply line.  
Power supply PCB  
NO  
Replace the power supply  
PCB.  
+
Output voltage  
+24V  
J208-1  
J208-3  
J208-4  
J209-4  
J210-1  
J210-8  
J211-7  
J211-5  
J208-2  
J208-5  
J208-5  
J209-3  
J210-2  
J210-2  
J211-1  
J211-1  
+5VU  
+5VR  
+24V  
+24V  
+5VU  
+24V  
+5VU  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
22.The scanner fails to move.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Belt, Cable  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Are the scanner drive belt and cable routed  
correctly?  
Route the belt and cable  
correctly, and check the  
pulley.  
Scanner path  
2
Is the scanner rail free of soiling and object,  
and does the scanner move smoothly when  
pushed by hand?  
NO  
Remove any dirt and object;  
check for an object that may  
come into contact with the  
scanner. As necessary, clean  
and lubricate, or repair.  
Note:  
If the rail is soiled, clean it  
with alcohol, and then apply  
a small amount of oil.  
Scanner motor (M2)  
DC controller PCB  
3
Replace the scanner. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES  
NO  
End.  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the scanner  
motor; if normal, replace the  
DC controller PCB.  
10–54  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
23.The lens fails to move.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Actions  
Bolt  
Is the lens drive belt routed correctly?  
Correct the belt, and check the  
gears.  
Lens path  
2
Is the lens path free of dirt and foreign  
object? Does the lens move smoothly when  
pushed by hand?  
Remove any dirt and object;  
check for any object that may  
come into contact with the  
lens. As necessary, clean and  
lubricate, or repair.  
NO  
Lens motor (M3)  
3
Replace the lens motor. Is the problem  
corrected?  
End.  
YES  
NO  
DC controller PCB  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the lens  
motor; if normal, replace the  
DC controller PCB.  
24.The mirror fails to move.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Mirror path  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Turn off the power, and move the mirror  
assembly by hand. Does it move smoothly?  
Remove any dirt or foreign  
object in the mirror path. As  
necessary, clean and lubricate  
the path.  
Mirror motor (M4)  
DC controller PCB  
2
Replace the mirror motor. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
NO Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the mirror  
motor; if normal, replace the  
DC controller PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
25.The scanning lamp fails to turn on.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Scanning lamp  
(LA1)  
Disconnect the power plug  
from the power outlet, and  
mount the scanning lamp  
correctly.  
Is the scanning lamp mounted correctly?  
Thermal fuse (FU1)  
2
Replace the thermal fuse.  
Disconnect the power plug from the power  
outlet, and remove the thermal fuse. Is there  
electrical continuity when the probes of the  
meter are connected across both terminals of  
the thermal fuse?  
NO  
Caution:  
The scanning lamp may have  
turned on abnormally, the  
thermal fuse may have been  
mounted incorrectly, or the  
cooling fan may have  
malfunctioned. Be sure to  
find out the cause.  
Scanning lamp  
(LA1)  
3
4
5
Replace the scanning lamp.  
Set the meter range to ‘ýx1’, and disconnect  
the connector J55. Does the meter index  
swing when the probes of the meter are  
connected across both terminals of the  
scanning lamp?  
NO  
Lamp regulator PCB  
Wiring  
End.  
Replace the lamp regulator PCB. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES  
NO  
Check the AC harness from  
the power supply PCB and the  
lamp regulator PCB and the  
scanning lamp. Check the DC  
harness from the DC  
controller PCB to the lamp  
regulator PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
Set the meter range to the 30 VDC, and  
connect the probes of the meter to J106-4 (+)  
and J105-5 (-) on the DC controller PCB.  
Does the voltage change from about 0 to 5 V  
when the Start key is pressed?  
NO  
10–56  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
26.The pre-exposure lamp fails to turn on.  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Pre-exposure lamp  
(LA2)  
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the probes to J104-A6 (+) and J104-7 (-) on  
the DC controller PCB. Does the voltage  
change from 0 to 24 V when the Start key is  
pressed?  
YES Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the pre-  
exposure lamp; if normal,  
replace the pre-exposure lamp.  
DC controller PCB  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
27.The blank exposure lamp fails to turn on.  
Yes/No  
YES  
Cause  
Actions  
End.  
Step  
1
Checks  
Blank exposure lamp  
(LA3)  
Replace the blank exposure lamp. Is the  
problem corrected?  
NO  
DC controller PCB  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the blank  
exposure lamp; if normal,  
replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
28.Pick-up fails. (cassette)  
Cause  
Copy paper  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
NO  
Are the size of the copy paper in the cassette  
and the size indicated by the cassette size  
indicator identical?  
Set the cassette size indicator  
once again.  
Right door  
Is the right door closed securely?  
Close the right door securely.  
2
3
NO  
Is the leading edge of copy paper as far as  
the registration roller?  
See "The registration roller  
fails to rotate."  
YES  
Pick-up roller  
Is the pick-up roller soiled or worn?  
If the pick-up roller is soiled,  
clean it with alcohol. If it is  
deformed by wear, replace it.  
4
5
YES  
NO  
Registration clutch  
(CL1), Feeding  
clutch (CL2)  
Open the right door, and press the Copy  
Start key while holding paper over the right  
door open/closed sensor. Does the feeding  
roller or the pull-out roller rotate?  
Check the drive gear for  
damage. Check the wiring  
from the DC controller PCB  
to each clutch; if normal  
replace the clutch.  
Pick-up solenoid  
(SL1)  
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the meter probes to J107-B8(+) and J107-  
B9(-). Does the voltage reading change from  
0 to 24 V when the Start key is pressed?  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to SL1; if  
normal, replace SL1.  
6
NO  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
YES  
10–58  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
29.Pick-up operation fails. (multifeeder)  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Is the leading edge of copy paper as far as the YES See “The registration roller  
registration roller?  
fails to rotate.”  
Multifeeder solenoid  
(SL2)  
2
3
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the probes to J107-B3 (+) and J107-B4 (-) on  
the DC controller PCB. Does the voltage  
change from 0 to 24 V when the Start key is  
pressed?  
YES Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the  
multifeeder solenoid; if  
normal, replace the solenoid.  
DC controller PCB  
NO Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
Multifeeder roller  
clutch (CL3)  
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the probes to J107-B1 (+) and J107-B2 (-).  
Does the voltage change from 0 to 24 V  
when the Start key is pressed?  
YES Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to multifeeder  
roller clutch; if normal,  
replace the clutch.  
DC controller PCB  
NO Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
30.The registration roller fails to rotate.  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Registration paper  
sensor (PS5)  
Is the registration paper sensor normal?  
(See the instructions on how to check  
photointerrupters.)  
NO Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the  
registration paper sensor; if  
normal, replace the sensor.  
Registration roller  
clutch (CL1)  
2
Set the meter to the 30 VDC, and connect  
the probes to J211-7 (+) and J211-6 (-).  
Does the voltage change from 0 to 24 V  
when the Start key is pressed?  
YES Check the drive gear for  
damage. Check the wiring  
from the DC controller PCB  
to registration roller clutch; if  
normal, replace the clutch.  
DC controller PCB  
NO Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
31.The fixing heater fails to turn on.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Thermal switch  
(TSW1)  
Turn off the power switch, and remove the  
fixing assembly. Set the meter range to  
x1.” Does the meter index swing when  
the probes are connected across both  
terminals of the thermal switch?  
Replace the thermal switch.  
Fixing heater (H1)  
2
3
Turn off the power switch, and remove the  
fixing assembly. Is there continuity when  
probes are connected across both terminals  
of the fixing heater?  
NO  
NO  
Replace the fixing heater.  
DC controller PCB  
Wiring  
Set the meter range to 30 VDC, and connect  
the probes to J106-21 (+) and J105-4 (-) on  
the DC controller PCB. Is the resistance  
about 5 V?  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
YES Check the AC harness from  
the DC power supply PCB to  
the fixing heater. Check the  
DC harness from the DC  
controller PCB to the DC  
power supply PCB.  
32.The Add Toner indicator does not flash/turn on.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Connector  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Are the connector J15 of the toner sensor,  
relay connectors J721 and J722, and the  
connector J102 on the DC controller PCB  
connected securely?  
Connect the connectors  
securely.  
Toner sensor (TS1)  
Control panel PCB  
2
3
Replace the toner sensor. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
Execute service mode ‘409’ (control panel  
check). Does the Add Toner indicator turn  
on?  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PC to the control  
panel PCB; if normal, replace  
the control panel PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
10–60  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
33.The Add Toner indicator fails to turn off.  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Open and close the front door. Does it turn  
off?  
YES End.  
Connector  
2
3
Are the connector J15 of the toner sensor,  
relay connectors J721 and 720, and  
connector J102 on the DC controller PCB on  
the DC controller PCB connected securely?  
NO  
Connect the connectors  
securely.  
Toner sensor (TS1)  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the toner sensor. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES End.  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
34.The Waste Toner Box Full indicator fails to flash/turn on.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Connector  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Are the connectors up to the waste toner  
sensor connected securely?  
Connect the connectors  
securely.  
Waste toner sensor  
Control panel PCB  
2
3
Replace the waste toner sensor. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
Execute service mode ‘409’ (control panel  
check). Does the Waste Toner Box Full  
indicator turn on?”  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the control  
panel PCB; if normal, replace  
the control panel PCB.  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
35.The Waste Toner Box Full indicator fails to turn off.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Waste toner box  
Is the waste toner box mounted?  
Install the waste toner box.  
2
3
Is the waste toner box full?  
YES Replace the waste toner box.  
Waste toner box  
Connector  
Is the mouth of the waste toner box soiled?  
YES Clean it. If the dirt cannot be  
removed, replace the waste  
toner box.  
4
5
Are the connectors to the waste toner sensor  
connected securely?  
NO  
Connect the connectors  
securely.  
Waste toner sensor  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the waste toner sensor. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES End.  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
36.The Add Paper indicator fails to flash.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Sensor (PS4, PS7)  
Check the wiring from the  
sensor lever and each sensor to  
the DC controller PCB; if  
normal, replace the sensor.  
Are the following sensors normal? (See the  
instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupers.)  
PS4  
PS7  
Cassette paper sensor  
Multi paper sensor  
Control panel PCB  
DC controller PCB  
2
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the control  
panel PCB; if normal, replace  
the control panel PCB.  
Execute service mode ‘409’ (control panel  
check). Does the Add Paper indicator turn  
on?  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
YES  
10–62  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
37.The Add Paper indicator fails to turn off.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Cassette  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Is the cassette set correctly?  
Set the cassette correctly.  
Sensor (PS4, PS7)  
2
Are the following sensors normal? (See the  
instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupers.)  
NO  
Check the wiring from the  
sensor lever and each sensor to  
the DC controller PCB; if  
normal, replace the sensor.  
PS4  
PS7  
Cassette paper sensor  
Multi paper sensor  
DC controller PCB  
YES Replace the DC controller.  
38.The Jam indicator fails to flash.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Sensor (PSS5, PS6)  
Are the following sensors normal? (See the  
instruction on how to check the  
photointerrupters.)  
Check the wiring from the  
sensor lever and each sensor to  
the DC controller PCB; if  
normal, replace the sensor.  
PS5  
PS6  
Registration paper sensor  
Delivery paper sensor  
Control panel PCB  
DC controller PCB  
2
Execute service mode ‘409’ (control panel  
check). Does the Jam indicator turn on?  
NO  
Check the wiring from the DC  
controller PCB to the control  
panel PCB; if normal, replace  
the control panel PCB.  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
39.The Jam indicator fails to turn off.  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Has all paper been removed from inside the  
copier?  
Remove the paper.  
2
3
Execute service mode ‘101’ (jam type  
display) to find out which sensor detected the  
jam. Is there paper around the sensor?  
Remove the paper.  
YES  
NO  
Sensor  
Is the sensor of step 2 normal? (See the  
instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupters.)  
Check the wiring from the  
sensor lever and each sensor to  
the DC controller PCB; if  
normal, replace the sensor.  
DC controller PCB  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
40.The Set Control Card indicator fails to turn on.  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Control Card IV N  
Can copies be made without setting the  
Control Card IV N?  
YES Check the connector of the  
Control Card IV N for a short  
circuit.  
Control panel PCB  
DC controller PCB  
2
Replace the control panel PCB. Does the  
indicator turn on?  
YES End.  
NO  
Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
10–64  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
41.The Set Control Card indicator fails to turn off.  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Control card  
Is the Control Card set correctly?  
YES Set the control card correctly.  
DC controller PCB  
Control Card IV N  
2
Can copies be made?  
YES Replace the DC controller  
PCB.  
NO  
Replace the Control Card IV  
N.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
V. TROUBLESHOOTING FEEDING PROBLEMS  
A. Copy Jams  
The copier may be divided into the following in terms of where copy paper tends to jam.  
[1] Pick-up/feeding assembly  
[2] Fixing/delivery assembly  
The instructions on how to remove copy paper in the following tables are organized  
according to location.  
You may find out the location and the nature of each jam in service mode (‘107’).  
[2]  
[1]  
Figure 10-501  
10–66  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
1. Pick-Up/Feeding Assembly  
Yes/No  
NO  
Cause  
Actions  
Go to step 8.  
Step  
1
Checks  
Does the jam occur when paper is picked up  
from the cassette?  
Cassette  
2
3
4
Is the cassette set in the copier correctly?  
NO  
Set the cassette correctly.  
Try a different cassette. Is the problem  
corrected?  
YES Check the inside of the  
cassette for foreign matter.  
Copy paper  
Is the copy paper curled, wavy, or the like?  
YES Replace the copy paper.  
Instruct the user on the correct  
method of storing copy paper.  
5
6
Try paper of a type recommended by Canon.  
Is the problem corrected?  
YES Advise the user to use  
recommended paper.  
DC controller PCB,  
Pick-up clutch  
Does the pick-up roller of the selected  
cassette holder rotating during copying  
operation?  
NO  
See “The pick-up operation  
fails.”  
Pick-up roller  
Separation roller  
Feeding roller  
7
8
9
Is the pick-up roller deformed or worn?  
Is the separation roller deformed or worn?  
Is the feeding roller deformed or worn?  
YES Replace the pick-up roller.  
YES Replace the separation roller.  
YES Replace the feeding roller.  
Registration roller  
drive assembly  
10 Does the registration roller operate  
normally?  
NO  
See “The registration roller  
fails to rotate.”  
Registration roller  
vertical path roller  
11 Is the registration roller or the vertical path  
roller deformed or worn?  
YES Replace the roller.  
Transfer charging  
assembly  
12 Is the transfer charging assembly set  
correctly?  
NO  
Check the transfer charging  
assembly.  
13 Is there foreign matter on the paper guide of  
the transfer charging assembly?  
YES Remove the foreign matter.  
14 Make a copy in manual mode. Does the  
main motor rotate?  
NO  
See “The pick-up operation  
fails.”  
Copy paper  
15 Try paper recommended by Canon. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES Advise the user to use  
recommended paper.  
Pick-up roller  
NO  
Check the pick-up roller for  
deformation and wear.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
2. Fixing/Delivery Assembly  
Cause  
Step  
1
Checks  
Yes/No  
YES  
Actions  
Separation claw  
(delivery assembly)  
Is the separation claw worn, deformed, or  
soiled?  
1. Replace the separation  
claw.  
2. If dirt is found, clean it.  
Upper/lower  
fixing roller,  
Heat  
2
Is the upper/lower fixing roller or the heat  
discharging roller deformed or damaged?  
YES  
Replace the roller.  
discharging  
roller  
Paper guide  
3
Is the paper guide soiled with toner or the  
like?  
YES Clean the paper guide.  
4
5
Is the height of the paper guide correct?  
NO  
YES Adjust it.  
Adjust the height.  
Nip  
Is the lower roller pressure (nip) as  
indicated?  
Delivery lever  
6
7
Does the delivery detecting lever move  
smoothly?  
NO  
NO  
Adjust the lever so that it  
moves smoothly.  
Delivery paper  
sensor  
(PS06)  
Does the delivery sensor operate normally?  
(See the instructions on how to check the  
photointerrupters.)  
Replace the sensor.  
Delivery roller  
drive assembly  
8
Does the delivery roller move smoothly?  
NO  
Check the delivery roller drive  
assembly.  
YES Check the copy to see if it has  
a leading edge.  
Leading edge  
margin  
10–68  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
B. Faulty Feeding  
1. Double Feeding  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Separation pad  
Is the separation pad deformed, worn, or  
soiled?  
YES Replace the separation pad.  
Spring  
NO  
Push up the separation pad,  
and replace the spring.  
Separation roller  
Spring  
2
Is the separation roller deformed, worn, or  
soiled?  
YES Replace the separation roller.  
NO  
Replace the spring used to pull  
the separation roller.  
2. Wrinkles  
Yes/No  
Cause  
Actions  
Step  
1
Checks  
Pick-up assembly  
Turn off the power while copy paper is  
moving through the feeding assembly. Is the  
paper wrinkled? Or, is the paper askew?  
YES Check the pick-up assembly.  
Check the registration roller.  
Copy paper  
2
Try copy paper fresh out of package. Is the  
problem corrected?  
YES The copy paper may be moist.  
Instruct the user on the correct  
method of storing copy paper.  
3
4
5
6
Is the paper of a type recommended by  
Canon?  
NO  
Advise the user to use  
recommended paper.  
Paper guide  
Is the paper guide soiled with toner or the  
like?  
YES Clean it.  
Is the height of the paper guide correct?  
Is the lower roller (nip) as indicated?  
NO  
NO  
Adjust the height of the paper  
guide.  
Lower roller  
pressure  
Adjust it  
Upper/lower  
roller  
YES Try replacing the top unit or  
the lower roller.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
VI. ARRANGEMENT AND FUNCTIONS OF  
ELECTRICAL PARTS  
A. Sensors and Switches  
PS11  
PS7  
PS9  
PS10  
PS4  
PS5  
PS6  
TS1  
PS3  
PS2  
PS1  
PS8  
DS1  
SW1  
Figure 10-601  
10–70  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Name  
Description  
Notation  
TS1  
Symbol  
Toner sensor  
Developing assembly toner level detection  
Photointerrupter  
PS1  
PS2  
PS3  
PS4  
PS5  
PS6  
PS7  
PS8  
PS9  
PS10  
PS11  
Scanner home position detection  
Lens home position detection  
Mirror home position detection  
Cassette paper detection  
Registration paper detection  
Delivery detection  
Multifeeder paper detection  
Waste toner feeding screw locked detection  
Multifeeder paper width detection 1  
Multifeeder paper width detection 2  
Right door open/closed detection  
Switch  
SW1  
DS1  
Heater switch (accessory)  
Front door switch  
Table 10-601  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
B. Motors, Fans, Clutches, and Solenoids  
CL3  
CL2  
SL2  
SL1  
M4  
M2  
M3  
FM5  
FM4  
FM2  
FM1  
M1  
CL1  
Figure 10-602  
10–72  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Name  
Description  
Notation  
M1  
M2  
M3  
M4  
Symbol  
Main drive  
Scanner drive  
Lens drive  
Motor  
M
No. 4/No. 5 mirror drive  
Cooling  
FM1  
FM2  
FM4  
FM5  
Fan  
Heat discharge  
Heat discharge  
Heat discharge (accessory)  
Registration roller clutch  
Feeding clutch  
Multifeeder pick-up clutch  
CL1  
CL2  
CL3  
Clutch  
CL  
SL  
Pick-up solenoid  
Multifeeder pick-up solenoid  
SL1  
SL2  
Solenoid  
Table 10-602  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
C. Heaters, Lamps, and Others  
TH3  
H2  
TH1  
RL1  
VZ1  
TP1  
TH2  
H1  
LA3  
FU1  
LA2  
LA1  
CNT1  
CNT2  
H3  
Figure 10-603  
10–74  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Name  
Description  
Notation  
H1  
Symbol  
Fixing heater  
Heater  
Cassette/drum heater (accessory)  
Mirror heater (accessory)  
H2  
H3  
Scanning lamp  
LA1  
Lamp  
LED  
Pre-exposure lamp  
Blank exposure lamp  
LA2  
LA3  
LED  
CNT  
Total copy counter  
Accessory counter  
CNT1  
CNT2  
Counter  
Fixing heater power supply control  
Scanning lap overheating detection  
Fixing assembly overheating detection  
RL1  
Relay  
FU1  
Thermal fuse  
Thermal switch  
Thermistor  
Cleaner thermistor  
Varistor  
TSW1  
Fixing roller surface temperature detection 1  
Fixing roller surface temperature detection 2  
TH1  
TH2  
Ambient temperature detection  
Varistor  
TH3  
VZ1  
Table 10-603  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
D. PCBs  
4
6
5
3
2
7
9
1
8
Figure 10-604  
Name  
Description  
Ref.  
Sequence control  
[1]  
[2]  
[3]  
[4]  
[5]  
[6]  
[7]  
[8]  
[9]  
DC controller PCB  
Control panel PCB  
AE sensor  
Lamp regulator PCB  
Power supply PCB  
High-voltage power supply PCB  
Waste toner sensor  
Cassette size switch PCB  
Accessory power supply PCB  
Control key/control display  
Original density detection  
Scanning lamp on voltage control  
Power supply  
High-voltage output  
Waste toner full detection  
Cassette size detection  
ADF and sorter DC power supply  
Table 10-604  
10–76  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
E. Variable Resistors, Light-Emitting Diodes, and Check Pins by  
PCB  
Of the variable resistors (VR), light-emitting diodes (LD), and check pins used in the copier,  
those needed for servicing work in the field are discussed.  
Caution:  
1.Some LEDs retain current even when off and emit dim light. This is a normal condition  
and must be kept in mind.  
2.VRs that may be used in the field.....................................................  
3.VRs that must not be used in the field..............................................  
Caution:  
Do not use the VRs or check pins not found in the tables. They are for factory use, and  
require special tools and high accuracy.  
1. DC Controller PCB  
B15  
A1  
B1  
B12  
A1  
B13  
A1  
2
1
B1  
B1  
B9  
A1  
8
1
B1  
A9  
J101  
J112  
J104  
J102  
J120  
J103  
A1  
1
A15  
A12  
A13  
J109  
J108  
3
1
4
B15  
B1  
J107  
A15  
1
J124  
J110  
5
3
1
J106  
A16  
A1  
5
1
5
1
1
8
5
1
J105  
J131  
J122  
SW102  
J121  
B1  
B16  
Figure 10-605  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Item  
Remarks  
SW102-1  
ON  
Use to change size.  
SW102-1  
Settings  
INCH  
SW102-2  
ON  
A
OFF  
ON  
AB/INCH  
AB  
ON  
OFF  
SW102-2  
OFF  
OFF  
SW102-3 Use to set power supply voltage.  
ON :230V  
OFF : 120V  
SW102-4  
Use to set the accessory  
counter.  
Settings  
SW102-5  
OFF  
ON  
SW102-6  
OFF  
SW102-5  
No accessory counter  
Small-size copy counter  
Large-size copy counter  
Not used  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
SW102-6  
ON  
SW102-7 Large size copy counting method  
ON: 2 counts  
OFF: 1 count  
SW102-8  
Table 10-605  
Inch-configuration (4R3E)  
Ratio  
200%  
200.0%  
129.4%  
121.4%  
LTR11"×17"  
LGL11"×17"  
100%  
100.0%  
LGLLTR  
11"×17"LGL  
11"×17"LTR  
50%  
78.6%  
73.3%  
64.7%  
50.0%  
Table 10-606  
A-configuration (2R2E)  
200%  
Ratio  
200.0%  
A4A3  
100%  
141.4%  
100.0%  
70.7%  
50.0%  
A3A4  
50%  
Table 10-607  
10–78  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
AB/Inch-configuration (4R4E)  
200%  
Ratio  
200.0%  
141.4%  
122.4%  
115.4%  
100.0%  
86.5%  
81.6%  
70.7%  
50.0%  
A4/LTRA3, B5B4  
A4/LTRB4  
B4A3, B5A4/LTR  
100%  
A3B4, A4/LTRB5  
B4A4/LTR  
A3A4/LTR, B4B5  
50%  
Table 10-608  
AB-configuration (4R4E)  
200%  
Ratio  
200.0%  
141.4%  
122.4%  
115.4%  
100.0%  
86.5%  
81.6%  
70.7%  
50.0%  
A4A3, B5B4  
A4B4  
B4A3, B5A4  
100%  
A3B4, A4B5  
B4A4  
A3A4, B4B5  
50%  
Table 10-609  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
2. Power Supply PCB  
4
J209  
5
1
1
J208  
J210  
J212  
10  
1
J211  
7
1
3
1
J204  
1
4
J206  
2
1
J203  
Figure 10-606  
3. Lamp Regulator PCB  
5
1
J503  
VR1  
VR2  
6
1
J501  
Figure 10-607  
10–80  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
4. High-Voltage Power Supply PCB  
1
2
2
1
J304  
J301  
J305  
10  
1
VR82  
VR83  
VR81  
VR52  
3
J302  
J303  
1
4
1
VR141  
3
VR52  
1
J306  
Figure 10-608  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
VII. SERVICE MODE  
A. Outline  
The copier’s service mode is divided into the following seven:  
No.  
[ 1 ]  
[ 2 ]  
[ 3 ]  
[ 4 ]  
[ 5 ]  
[ 6 ]  
[ 7 ]  
Description  
DISPLAY  
I/O DISPLAY  
ADJUST  
FUNCTION  
OPTION  
COUNTER  
APPLICATION  
Table 10-701  
B. Using Service Mode  
1. Starting Service Mode  
1) Press the User Mode key.  
• If you are planning to make checks as in I/O display mode while making copies, select the  
appropriate copying mode before pressing the User Mode key.  
2) Hold down the ‘2’ and ‘8’ keys on the keypad at the same time for 0.5 sec or more.  
3) Press the User Mode key once again.  
• The copier will indicate ‘[1]’ on its control panel as soon as it enters service mode.  
• The copier will end service mode in response to a press on the Reset key.  
2. Selecting Service Mode  
1) Select the mode you want for making checks or adjustments (Table 10-701) using the  
keypad.  
• The 10’s place will switch to indicate the input numeral.  
• The copier will start making copies in response to a press on the Start key using the settings  
that were effective immediately before the start of service mode.  
2) Press the AE key.  
• The copier will indicate a 3-digit number, and the 100’s place will start to flash and 10’ and  
1’s places will turn on.  
3) Select the mode you want to use for making checks or adjustments using the keypad.  
• The 10’s and 1’s places will serve to indicate the input numerals.  
• The copier will return to the condition in step 1) above in response to a press on the AE  
key.  
4) Press the Start key to execute the selected service mode.  
• The copier will return to the condition in step 3) in response to a press on the AE key while  
it is executing service mode.  
10–82  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
C. Using Adjust Mode and Function Mode  
In adjust mode and function mode, the copier stores the settings made on the control panel in  
the RAM on the DC controller PCB and use them to simulate the functions of conventional  
variable resistors and switches.  
Figure 10-701 shows the information sheet stored behind the copier’s front door. Each copier  
is adjusted at the factory, and the adjustment values are recorded in the sheet.  
If you have replaced the DC controller PCB or initialized the RAM, you will have to enter  
the values recorded in the information sheet into the RAM on the DC controller PCB. Moreover,  
if you have entered any values newly in the field, be sure to record the value in this sheet.  
TYP  
301 AE_ADJ  
302 LMP_ADJ  
303 AE_SLOP  
305 REGIST  
306 LE_BLANK  
307 PG_RGST  
308 PG_BLANK  
309 TE_BLANK  
319 MF_ARCH  
320 CST1_ARCH  
321 CST2_ARCH  
326 LIGHT_5  
327 LNS_HP  
328 MIRR_HP  
329 LNS_TBL  
330 MIRR_TBL  
331 MLT_CL  
332 MLT_TMG  
519  
MODEL_SW  
701 DOC_ST_L  
Figure 10-701  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
D. Display Mode [1]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, use the Start key.  
• To cancel an item, use the Clear key.  
No.  
101  
106  
Description  
Indicates the type of jam.  
Remarks  
Indicates the type of jam. (See Table 10-702.)  
E805  
Indicates the code of the fan that caused E805.  
“01: exhaust fan at rear (FM2)  
“02: exhaust fan at fount (FM4)  
“03: sorter kit fan (FM5)  
107  
108  
Indicates a history of jams.  
Indicates a history of errors.  
Indicates the most recent five jams. A press on ‘1’  
through ‘5’ keys will show the respective jams.  
(See Table 10-702.)  
Indicates the most recent five error codes. A press on  
‘1’ through ‘5’ keys will show their respective error  
codes and the number being pressed.  
109  
110  
111  
112  
Indicates the temperature detected by the fixing  
main thermistor (TH1).  
unit: °C  
unit: °C  
Indicates the temperature detected by the fixing  
sub thermistor (TH2).  
Indicates the temperature detected by the cleaner unit: °C  
thermistor (TH3).  
Indicates the output voltage of the AE sensor.  
A press on the Start key will execute AE scanning.  
The output voltage of the AE sensor is indicated in  
decimal notation using three digits (e.g., 245 V will be  
indicated as ‘245’).  
113  
114  
115  
Indicates the version of the ROM.  
Indicates the version of the program.  
Indicates the release number of the ROM.  
Indicates the jam history of the ADF.  
Indicates the release number of the program.  
Indicates the history of the most recent five jams. A  
press on the ‘1’ through ‘5’ keys will indicate the type  
of their respective jams. (See Table 10-703.)  
116  
Indicates the jam history of the sorter.  
Indicates the history of the most recent five jams. A  
press on the ‘1’ through ‘5’ keys will indicate the type  
of their respective jams. (See Table 10-705.)  
117  
118  
Indicates the type of jam in the ADF.  
Indicates the type of jam. (See Table 10-703.)  
Indicates the type of warning for the ADF.  
Indicates alarm codes of the ADF. (See Table 10-  
704.)  
119  
Indicates the version of the ROM of the ADF.  
Indicates the version of the program.  
10–84  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
No.  
120  
Description  
Remarks  
Indicates the release number of the ROM of the  
ADF.  
Indicates the release number of the program.  
121  
122  
123  
Indicates the type of jam in the sorter.  
Indicates the tray warning for the sorter.  
Indicates the stapling alarm for the sorter.  
Indicates the version of the ROM of the sorter.  
Indicates the type of jam in the sorter. (See Table 10-  
705.)  
Indicates the alarm code for the sorter. (See Table 10-  
706.)  
Indicates the alarm code for the sorter. (See Table 10-  
707.)  
124  
125  
Indicates the version of the program.  
Indicates the release number of the ROM of the  
sorter.  
Indicates the release number of the program.  
126  
Checks the keys on the control panel.  
See p. 10-87.  
Guide to Jam Types (No. 101) and Jam History (No. 107)  
• The type of jam is indicated using the following codes in the 10’s and 1’s places. In the case  
of the history, the number corresponding to the keys on the keypad will be indicated in the  
100’s place.  
Code  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
Description  
Registration delay jam  
Sensor  
PS5  
Registration stationary jam  
Registration paper sensor timing jam  
Delivery delay jam  
Delivery stationary jam  
Right door open jam  
Power-on jam  
PS6  
PS11  
PS5, PS6  
40  
ADF jam  
50  
Sorter jam  
Table 10-702  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Guide to ADF Jam History (No. 115) and ADF Jam Type (No. 117)  
• The type of jam is indicated using the following codes in the 10’s and 1’s places. In the case  
of the history, the number corresponding to the keys on the keypad will be indicated in the  
100’s place.  
Code  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
41  
42  
81  
82  
84  
87  
Description  
Separation extraction  
Separation delay  
Pick-up delay  
Pick-up leading edge skew  
Pick-up stationary  
Pick-up double feeding  
Pick-up trailing edge skew  
Pick-up trailing edge retreat  
Pick-up fault (leading edge)  
Delivery delay  
Delivery stationary  
Open  
Door open  
Jam original page  
Double feeding  
Table 10-703  
Guide to ADF Warning (No. 118)  
Code  
Description  
Tray sensor off  
Separation fault  
Separation skew  
Separation stopper override  
Original pages-jam recovery pages mismatch  
Original page in excess of 100  
Original extraction  
02  
03  
04  
05  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Original size error  
Table 10-704  
Guide to Sorter Jam History (No. 116) and Sorter Jam Type (No. 121)  
• The type of jam is indicated using the following codes in the 10’s and 1’s places. In the case  
of the history, the number corresponding to the keys on the keypad will be indicated in the  
100’s place.  
Code  
03  
04  
Description  
Feeding delay  
Feeding stationary  
Timing  
05  
06  
07  
Staple (stapler sorter only)  
Power-on  
08  
Door open  
Table 10-705  
10–86  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Guide to Sorter Tray Warning (No. 122)  
Code  
Description  
02  
Overstacking  
Table 10-706  
Guide to Sorter Stapling Warning (No. 123)  
Code  
Description  
Stapler down  
Staple  
Stapler safety protection  
Edging fault  
Stapling overstacking  
Staple stacking limit  
Mixed paper sizes (breadthwise)  
Staple unit absent  
Paper in stapler  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
0A  
Staple absent  
Table 10-707  
Checking the Control Panel Keys (No. 126)  
1) While the copier is in mode No. 126, press all keys on the control panel except the Start key.  
2) Press the Start key.  
• If ‘000’ is indicated on the control panel, all keys are normal.  
• If an error key is found, the copier will indicate its respective code (Table 10-708).  
If multiple keys are found to be faulty, the copier will indicate the lowest-number code  
only.  
Code  
Key  
Code  
17 Interrupt key  
18 Energy Saver key  
19 Clear key  
Key  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Sorter key  
Auto Zoom key  
Photo key  
Image Combination / Two-page Separation key 20 ID key  
AE key  
21 Number 0 key  
Stop key  
Start key  
Reduce key  
1:1 key  
22 Number 1 key  
23 Number 2 key  
24 Number 3 key  
25 Number 4 key  
26 Number 5 key  
27 Number 6 key  
28 Number 7 key  
29 Number 8 key  
30 Number 9 key  
31 Fit Image key  
10 Enlarge key  
11 Paper Select key  
12 % key  
13 + Zoom key  
14 - Zoom key  
15 Reset key  
16 Additional Functions key  
Table 10-708  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
E. I/O Display Mode [2]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, use the Start key.  
• To cancel an item, use the Clear key.  
No.  
201  
202  
203  
204  
205  
206  
Description  
Remarks  
Not used.  
Indicates digit 4.  
Indicates digit 5.  
Indicates digit 6.  
Indicates digit 7.  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates the voltage of the fixing main  
thermistor (TH1).  
Indicates the detected voltage.  
(e.g., 2.78 V will be indicated as ‘278’.)  
207  
208  
209  
216  
Indicates the voltage of the fixing sub thermistor Indicates the detected voltage.  
(TH2).  
(e.g., 2.78 V will be indicated as ‘278’.)  
Indicates the voltage of the AE sensor.  
Indicates the detected voltage.  
(e.g., 2.78 V will be indicated as ‘278’.)  
Indicates the voltage of the cleaner thermistor  
(TH3).  
Indicates the detected voltage.  
(e.g., 2.78 V will be indicated as ‘278’.)  
Indicates the voltage of the density adjusting  
volume (VR1).  
Indicates the detected voltage.  
(e.g., 2.78 V will be indicated as ‘278’.)  
219  
220  
221  
222  
223  
224  
225  
Indicates CPU port 6.  
Indicates CPU port 8.  
Not used.  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates PIO1B.  
Indicates PI03B.  
Not used.  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Indicates the state of input. (See p. 10-89.)  
Not used.  
10–88  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Guide to Nos. 202, 203, 204, 205, 219, 220, 222, and 223  
2a  
1a  
2b  
1f  
1b  
1g  
2c  
1e  
1c  
2d  
1d  
Figure 10-702  
No. LED  
Description  
Notation  
Signal  
Connector  
Remarks  
201 1a  
1b  
1c  
1d  
1e  
1f  
1g  
2a  
2b  
2c  
2d  
202 1a Detects the presence/absence of the CNT1 TCNT_DR* J102-A10 ON: present.  
total copy counter.  
1b Detects the presence/absence of  
paper in cassette 1.  
1c Detects the presence/absence of a  
control card.  
PS4  
CSTPDT  
J107-B12 ON: present.  
J104-A10 ON: absent.  
J107-B7 ON: closed.  
CCDT*  
Detects the state (open/closed) of  
1d  
PS11  
RDOPDT  
the right door.  
1e  
1f  
1g  
2a  
2b Detects paper in the multifeeder.  
2c Detects the width of paper in the  
multifeeder (1).  
PS7  
PS9  
MLTPDT0  
MLTPDT1 J107-A11  
J107-A8 ON: present.  
2d Detects the width of paper in the  
multifeeder (2).  
PS10 MLTPDT2 J107-A14  
Table 10-709a  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
No. LED  
Description  
Notation  
Signal  
Connector  
Remarks  
203 1a  
1b  
1c Detects the presence/absence of an  
accessories counter.  
CNT2 OPCNT_DR* J102-A12 ON: present.  
1d  
1e Detects the rotation of the scanner  
cooling fan (front).  
FM1  
SCFAN_DT*  
J104-B2 ON: on.  
1f  
EXFAN0_DT*  
EXFAN1_DT*  
1g Detects the rotation of the exhaust fan. FM4  
2a Detects the rotation of the exhaust fan. FM2  
J104-B8 ON: on.  
J104-B11 ON: on.  
2b  
2c  
2d  
204 1a Cassette 1 size detection 0  
1b Cassette 1 size detection 1  
1c Cassette 1 size detection 2  
1d Cassette 1 size detection 3  
SW651  
SW652  
SW653  
SW654  
CSTS0  
CSTS1  
CSTS2  
CSTS3  
J110-4  
J110-3  
J110-2  
J110-1  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
1e  
1f  
1g  
2a  
2b  
2c  
2d  
205 1a DSW102-1 setting  
1b DSW102-2 setting  
1c DSW102-3 setting  
1d DSW102-4 setting  
1e DSW102-5 setting  
1f DSW102-6 setting  
1g DSW102-7 setting  
2a DSW102-8 setting  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
ON: on.  
2b  
2c  
2d IPC detection (presence/absence)  
ON: absence.  
219 1a  
1b Mirror home position detection  
1c Lens home position detection  
PS3  
PS2  
MRRHP  
LNSHP  
J103-B8 OFF: at HP.  
J103-B5 OFF: at HP.  
1d  
1e  
1f  
1g  
2a  
2b  
2c  
2d  
Table 10-709b  
10–90  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
No. LED  
Description  
Notation  
Signal  
Connector  
Remarks  
220 1a Scanner home position detection  
PS1  
SCHP  
J103-B2 OFF: at HP.  
1b  
1c  
1d  
1e  
1f  
1g  
2a  
2b  
2c  
H1  
2d  
221 1a  
1b  
1c  
1d  
1e  
1f  
1g  
2a  
2b  
2c  
2d  
J106-9  
222 1a Waste toner box full detection  
1b Main heater triac short circuit detection  
TNFDT  
ON: full.  
ON: on.  
1c  
1d Scanning lamp on detection  
1e Toner level detection  
1f Delivery detection  
LA1  
TS1  
PS6  
PS5  
LMPDT  
TNEMP  
EXITPD  
RGPDT  
J106-6  
ON: on.  
J102-B2 ON: present.  
J124-2 ON: present.  
J107-A2 ON: present.  
1g Pre-registration paper detection  
2a  
2b  
2c  
2d  
223 1a  
1b  
1c  
1d  
1e Zero-cross direction detection  
1f Waste toner feedscrew lock detection PS8  
TRQMLDT J106-10  
1g  
M1  
MM_LKDT*  
2a Main motor (M1) lock detection  
J106-16 ON: motor off.  
2b  
2c  
2d  
Table 10-709c  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
F. Adjust Mode [3]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, press the Start key.  
• To change a setting, use the keypad or the +/- Zoom key.  
• To enter a value, press the Start key.  
• To remove an item, press the AE key.  
Settings  
No.  
301  
Description  
Remarks  
Executes AE auto adjustment.  
Use it to perform AE adjustment.  
(See p. 10-19.)  
302  
Adjust the lamp intensity for AE mode.  
A higher setting will increase the intensity of  
the scanning lamp (LA1), making the copies  
lighter. (Use it when performing AE  
adjustment.)  
450 – 750  
(120V model)  
0 – 590  
(230V model)  
303  
305  
Adjusts the copy density (developing  
bias) slope for AE mode.  
A higher setting will make the copies lighter.  
(Use it when performing AE adjustment.)  
0 – 255  
0 – 500  
Adjust the leading edge margin  
(registration roller clutch CL1 activation  
timing).  
A higher setting will delay pick-up of copy paper  
in relation to the image, thereby decreasing the  
leading edge margin. (unit: 0.21 mm)  
306  
307  
Adjusts the leading edge non-image  
width (blank exposure lamp LA3 de-  
activation timing).  
A higher setting will delay de-activation of the  
lamp, thereby increasing the leading edge non-  
image width. (unit: 0.21 mm)  
0 – 500  
0 – 500  
Adjusts the leading edge registration on  
right pages in page separation  
(registration roller clutch CL1 activation  
timing).  
A higher setting will delay pick-up of copy  
paper in relation to the image, thereby  
decreasing the leading edge margin. (unit: 0.21  
mm)  
308  
Adjusts the leading edge margin on right  
pages in page separation mode (blank  
exposure lamp LA3 de-activation  
timing).  
A higher setting will delay de-activation of the  
lamp, thereby increasing the leading edge non-  
image width. (unit: 0.21 mm)  
0 – 500  
309  
319  
320  
321  
Adjusts the trailing edge margin (blank  
exposure lamp LA3 activation timing).  
A higher setting will advance activation of the  
lamp, thereby increasing the trailing edge  
margin. (unit: 0.21 mm)  
0 – 500  
0 – 200  
0 – 100  
0 – 100  
Adjusts the arching in multifeeder mode  
(de-activation of the multifeeder pick-up  
roller clutch CL3).  
A higher setting will delay deactivation of the  
clutch, thereby increasing arching. (unit; 0.21  
mm)  
Adjusts the arching in cassette 1 pick-up  
mode (de-activation of pick-up roller  
clutch CL2).  
A higher setting will increase the arching.  
(unit: 0.42 mm)  
Adjusts the arching in cassette 2 pick-up  
mode (de-activation of the pick-up roller  
clutch).  
A higher setting will delay de-activation of the  
clutch, thereby increasing the arching. (unit:  
0.42 mm)  
10–92  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
No.  
326  
Description  
Settings  
Remarks  
Adjusts the activation voltage of the  
scanning lamp.  
450 – 660 A higher setting will increase the intensity of  
(120V model) the scanning lamp (LA1), making the copies  
0 – 390  
lighter.  
(230V model)  
327  
328  
329  
Adjusts the position of the lens (Direct at  
100%).  
0 – 200  
0 – 400  
0 – 3  
A higher setting will enlarge the image.  
(unit:0.1 mm)  
Adjusts mirror home position (at 100%  
ratio).  
A higher setting will enlarge the image. (unit:  
0.1 mm)  
Selects a table for lens travel to suit  
reproduction ratio.  
If you replaced the DC controller PCB or  
initialized the RAM, be sure to enter the value  
recorded on the Service Label stored behind the  
front door.  
330  
331  
Selects a table for No. 4/No. 5 mirror  
travel to suit reproduction ratio.  
0 – 3  
If you replaced the DC controller PCB or  
initialized the RAM, be sure to enter the value  
recorded on the Service Label stored behind the  
front door.  
Adjusts the timing of activation of the  
multifeeder pick-up clutch (CL3).  
0 – 999  
A higher setting will delay activation of the  
clutch. (unit: 0.02 sec)  
• If pick-up failure occurs, decrease the  
setting.  
• If double feeding occurs, increase the  
setting.  
Use this mode if double feeding or pick-  
up failure cannot be corrected by  
adjusting the pressure of the separation  
pad.  
332  
Adjusts activation of the multifeeder  
pick-up clutch (CL3)  
0 – 999  
A higher setting will delay activation of the  
clutch. (unit: 0.02 sec)  
• If thick paper is not fed as far as the  
registration roller, increase the setting.  
Use this mode if pick-up failure occurs  
when using thick paper.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
G. Function Mode [4]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, use the Start key.  
• To stop an item, use the Stop key.  
• To clear an item, use the Clear key.  
Caution:  
Be sure that the copier is in standby state when executing any item.  
No.  
401  
Description  
Remarks  
Stirs toner.  
The developing assembly (main motor) will rotate 4  
min. (The pre-exposure lamp LA2 and the blank  
exposure lamp LA3 will turn on, and all high-voltage  
outputs will turn off.)  
402  
403  
Releases the multifeeder holding plate.  
Drum unit installation mode.  
Releases the multifeeder holding plate.  
The drum unit and developing assembly will rotate 40  
sec.  
Execute this mode at the time of drum unit  
installation or replacement.  
406  
408  
Checks the fixing nip.  
Checks the fixing nip. (The Stop key will be  
disabled.)  
Checks the activation of the scanning lamp  
(LA1).  
The scanning lamp will turn on for 5 sec.  
409  
410  
Checks all indicators on the control panel.  
All LEDs on the control panel will turn on for 5 sec.  
Checks the forward movement of the scanning  
lamp.  
The scanner moves forward while the + key is held  
down.  
The scanner moves in reverse while the - key is held  
down.  
411  
412  
440  
Checks the activation of the pre-exposure lamp  
(LA2).  
The pre-exposure lamp will turn on.  
Initializes E000, E001, E002, E003, or E004.  
Press the Start key while the error code (E000, E001,  
E002, E003, or E004) is indicated.  
Moves the scanner, lens, and No. 4/No. 5 mirror Execute this mode before transporting the machine so  
unit.  
that the scanner, lens, and No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit will  
be positioned for transportation.  
450  
Initializes the back-up RAM.  
Press ‘1’ on the keypad and the Start key in sequence.  
(The power will turn off, initializing all RAM data.)  
10–94  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
H. Option Mode [5]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, use the Start key.  
• To change settings, use the keypad or the + and - Zoom keys.  
• To store settings, use the Start key.  
• To cancel an item, use the Clear key.  
No.  
505  
506  
510  
Description  
Remarks  
Sets U1 size.  
Sets U2 size.  
See Table 10-710.  
See Table 10-710.  
Sets drum cleaning.  
0:  
1:  
Disable drum cleaning (standard).  
Execute drum cleaning for every 50 copies  
(standard in Chinese mode).  
To remove dirt from the surface of the  
photosensitive drum, toner is deposited on the  
2:  
Execute drum cleaning for every 25 copies.  
Execute drum cleaning for every 10 copies.  
surface after copying operation and the cleaning 3:  
blade is used to collect the toner together with  
the dirt. (In addition, LSTR is extended by 6.5  
sec.)  
511  
512  
513  
Sets the copying start temperature for auto start  
mode.  
0:  
1:  
140°C (standard)  
180°C  
Sets the copying start temperature.  
0:  
1:  
160°C (standard)  
180°C  
Sets the fixing target temperature for A3, A4,  
279 × 432mm (11" × 17"), LTR.  
0:  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
Standard target temperature  
Standard target temperature +10°C  
Standard target temperature + 5°C  
Standard target temperature - 5°C  
Standard target temperature -10°C  
514  
515  
516  
Sets the fixing target temperature for B4, B5, and 0:  
Standard target temperature  
LGL.  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
Standard target temperature +10°C  
Standard target temperature + 5°C  
Standard target temperature - 5°C  
Standard target temperature -10°C  
Sets the fixing target temperature for A4R, A5,  
B5R, and LTRR.  
0:  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
Standard target temperature  
Standard target temperature +10°C  
Standard target temperature + 5°C  
Standard target temperature - 5°C  
Standard target temperature -10°C  
Sets the fixing target temperature for A5R.  
0:  
1:  
2:  
3:  
4:  
Standard target temperature  
Standard target temperature +10°C  
Standard target temperature + 5°C  
Standard target temperature - 5°C  
Standard target temperature -10°C  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
No.  
517  
Description  
Remarks  
Enables/disables retry for cassette pick-up  
operation.  
0:  
Make a retry (standard).  
Indicates the Jam message in response to the  
second registration delay jam.  
Do not make a retry.  
Indicates the Jam message in response to the  
first registration delay jam.  
In cassette pick-up mode, pick-up operation will 1:  
be executed once again without indicating the  
first registration delay jam.  
518  
519  
Sets the count for the control card in multifeeder 0:  
Increment by 1 for all sizes (standard).  
Increment by 2 for all sizes.  
pick-up.  
1:  
Selects settings to suit the site of installation.  
0:  
1:  
Normal (standard)  
China  
Making changes using this mode will change the  
settings under ‘510’ as follows:  
• If ‘1’ is selected instead of ‘0’ in this mode,  
‘1’ will be set under ‘510’.  
The standard target temperature for fixing will  
be lowered by 10°C. In addition, ‘U14’ will be  
added to user mode.  
• If ‘0’ is selected instead of ‘1’ in this mode,  
‘0’ will be set under ‘510’.  
However, ‘510’ settings may be changed after  
making changes in this mode.  
Paper Sizes Available under No. 505/506  
Code  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Paper  
Size (vertical x horizontal in mm)  
216.0 x 355.0  
220.0 x 340.0  
220.0 x 340.0  
206.0 x 337.0  
215.9 x 330.2  
210.0 x 330.0  
203.2 x 330.2  
220.0 x 320.0  
216.0 x 317.0  
220.0 x 280.0  
190.0 x 268.0  
203.2 x 266.7  
280.0 x 220.0  
266.7 x 203.2  
268.0 x 190.0  
BOLIVIA  
ARGENTINE OFICIO  
ARGENTINE LEGAL  
AUSTRALIAN FOOLSCAP  
FOOLSCAP  
FOLIO  
GOVERNMENT LEGAL  
ECUADORAN OFICIO  
OFFICIO  
ARGENTINE LETTER R  
KOREAN LEGAL R  
GOVERNMENT LETTER R  
ARGENTINE LETTER  
GOVERNMENT LETTER  
KOREAN LEGAL  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Table 10-710  
10–96  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
I. Counter Mode [6]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, use the Start key.  
• To cancel an item, use the Clear key.  
• The result obtained by multiplying the indicated value by 100 will be the actual count.  
No.  
601  
602  
603  
604  
605  
606  
Description  
Large copy counter  
Remarks  
Small copy counter  
Total copy counter  
ADF large original page counter  
ADF small original page counter  
Count clear  
A press on the Start key will initialize the count (601  
to 605), returning it to ‘0’ on the control panel.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
J. Application Mode [7]  
• To select an item, use the keypad.  
• To execute an item, use the Start key.  
• To change the value, use the keypad or the + and - Zoom keys.  
• To store settings, use the Start key.  
• To cancel an item, use the Clear key.  
No.  
701  
Description  
Settings  
1–255  
Remarks  
Adjusts the ADF original page stop  
position.  
A lower setting will move the original page  
stop position in the direction of delivery.  
(unit: 0.116 mm)  
10–98  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
VIII. SELF DIAGNOSIS  
The microprocessor on the copier’s DC controller PCB is equipped with a function that  
checks the condition of the machine (especially the condition of sensors). It runs checks at such  
times as programmed, and will indicate any fault it finds in the form of code.  
A. Copier  
Cause  
Description  
Code  
• The thermistor (TH1, TH2) has poor  
contact or an open circuit.  
• The fixing heater (H1) has an open circuit.  
• The thermal switch (TSW1) has turned on.  
• The triac is faulty.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller does not reach 40°C within 14 sec  
after power-on.  
E000  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The thermistor (TH1, TH2) has a short  
circuit.  
• The triac is faulty.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller exceeded 230°C.  
E001  
E002  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The thermistor (TH1, TH2) has poor  
contact or an open circuit.  
• The fixing heater (H1) has an open circuit.  
• The thermal switch (TSW1) has turned on.  
• The triac is faulty.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller does not reach 60°C within 10 after it  
exceeded 40°C.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller does not reach 80°C within 10 sec  
after it exceeded 60°C.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller does not reach 100°C within 10 sec  
after it exceeded 80°C.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller does not reach 120°C within 10 sec  
after it exceeded 100°C.  
• The surface temperature of the fixing upper  
roller drops to 130°C or less after it  
reached the target temperature (160°C) for  
standby.  
• The thermistor (TH1, TH2) has poor  
contact or an open circuit.  
• The fixing heater (H1) has an open circuit.  
• The thermal switch (TSW1) has turned on.  
• The triac is faulty.  
E003  
E004  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The triac is identified as having a short  
circuit.  
• The triac has a short circuit.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Cause  
Description  
Code  
• The main motor (M1) is faulty.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The main motor lock detection signal  
(MM_LKDT*) is detected for 1 sec  
continuously while the main motor is being  
driven.  
E010  
• The waste toner feedscrew lock detection  
signal (TRQMLDT) does not switch for  
0.5 sec or more while the main motor is  
being driven.  
• The waste toner feedscrew is locked.  
• The waste toner feedscrew lock sensor  
(PS8) is faulty.  
E013  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The total copy counter is identified to have  
an open circuit when the Start key is  
pressed or when the counter is driven.  
• The total copy counter has an open  
circuit.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
E030  
E031  
• The accessories counter is identified as  
having an open circuit when the Start key  
is pressed or the couter is being driven.  
• The accessories counter has an open  
circuit.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The scanner does not return to home  
position within a specific period of time  
when it is being moved.  
• The scanner home position sensor (PS1)  
remains on during image exposure  
(forward movement).  
• The scanner home position sensor (PS1)  
is faulty.  
• The scanner motor (M2) is faulty.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
(E202)  
No code  
indication. Keys  
are disabled.  
(Note 2)  
• The No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit does not turn  
on or off the mirror home position sensor  
(PS3) within a specific period of time  
while the No. 4/No. 5 mirror unit is being  
moved.  
• The mirror home position sensor (PS3) is  
faulty.  
• The mirror motor (M4) is faulty.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
E208  
• The lens unit does not turn on or off the  
lens home position sensor (PS2) within a  
specific period of time when the lens unit is  
being moved.  
• The lens home position sensor (PS2) is  
faulty.  
• The lens motor (M3) is faulty.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
E210  
E220  
• The scanning lamp turns on during  
standby.  
• The scanning lamp turns off during  
copying.  
• The lamp regulator PCB is faulty.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The intervals of the zero-cross signals  
exceed the allowed intervals for 50/60 Hz.  
• The power supply frequency is faulty.  
• The power supply PCB is faulty.  
E261  
10–100  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Cause  
Description  
Code  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• IC114 (IPC) on the DC controller PCB  
cannot be initialized at power -on.  
E710  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• An IPC communication error has been  
detected twice or more within 1 sec at  
power-on.  
E711  
E712  
• A communication error with the ADF  
controller PCB cannot be cleared.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The ADF controller PCB is fault.  
• The ADF cable is faulty.  
• A condition in which a response from the  
Remote Diagnostic Device II cannot be  
received occurred three times  
continuously.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The Remote Diagnostic Device II PCB is  
faulty.  
E717  
• The Remote diagnostic Device II  
communicates an interruption of count  
pulses.  
• An open circuit is detected for 5 V or 24 V  
at power-on.  
• The auto power-off circuit has an open  
circuit.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
E800  
E805  
• The exhaust fan drive detection signal  
(EXFAN1_DT*, FXFAN0_DT*) cannot  
be detected 0.5 sec after the start of the  
exhaust fan (FM2, FM4).  
• The exhaust fan (FM2, FM4) is faulty.  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
• The cleaner thermistor (TH3) detects 55°C  
or more.  
• The ozone filter is clogged.  
• The cleaner thermistor (TH3) has poor  
contact or an open circuit.  
E821  
• The DC controller PCB is faulty.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
Note:  
1. When the diagnostic function has turned on, the copier can be reset by turning it off  
once. This, however, does not apply to E000, E001, E002, E003, or E004.  
This is to prevent the user from resetting the copier easily when the error is caused by  
an open circuit in the thermistor, otherwise overheating and damaging the fixing  
roller.  
Normally, the copier will automatically turn off in about 4 sec if it is turned on  
without clearing E000 through E004.  
To clear E000 through E004, operate as follows:  
1) Select ‘412’ (clear E000–E004) in service mode.  
• The copier’s control panel indicates the respective error code.  
2) Press the Start key.  
3) The copier will automatically turn off, clearing the error.  
2. E202 may be checked using ‘108’ in service mode (error history indication).  
10–102  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
B. ADF  
Code  
Cause  
Description  
• The communication is monitored at all  
times. This error occurs when the  
communication with the copier stops.  
• Exchange of data with the copier has a  
fault.  
E400  
• See the ADF Service Manual.  
• See the ADF Service Manual.  
• See the ADF Service Manual.  
• See the ADF Service Manual.  
• The separation motor does not rotate.  
• The crescent sensor is faulty.  
E401  
E402  
E403  
E404  
• The belt motor does not rotate.  
• The belt clock is faulty.  
• The feed motor does not rotate.  
• The feed motor clock is faulty.  
• The delivery motor does not rotate.  
• The delivery clock is faulty.  
• See the ADF Service Manual.  
• See the ADF Service Manual.  
• The sensor level is faulty.  
E411  
E431  
• The auto start separation motor does not  
rotate.  
• The auto start crescent sensor is faulty.  
• The auto start separation clock is faulty.  
Note:  
When the self diagnosis function has turned on, the ADF may be reset by turning off the  
copier.  
To continue making copies while the ADF is out of order, disconnect the lattice  
connector on the ADF side, open the ADF, and place an original on the copyboard glass.  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
10–103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 10 TROUBLESHOOTING  
C. Sorter  
Code  
Cause  
Description  
• Communication is monitored at all times.  
This error occurs when the communication  
with the copier stops.  
• Exchange of data with the copier is  
faulty.  
E500  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Stapler Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• See the Sorter Service Manual.  
• The feed motor does not rotate.  
• The feed motor rotates too slowly.  
• The tandem path motor does not rotate.  
• The stack motor does not rotate.  
• The alignment motor does not rotate.  
• The stapler drive motor does not rotate.  
• The shift motor does not rotate.  
• The shift motor rotates too slowly.  
• A timing jam has occurred.  
E510  
E511  
E513  
E520  
E530  
E531  
E540  
E541  
E550  
D. Cassette Feeding Module  
Code  
Cause  
Description  
• The waste toner box swing cam does not  
return to home position within a specific  
period of time when the waste toner box  
swing cam is being driven.  
• The waste toner box swing cam home  
position sensor is faulty.  
• The cassette relay PCB is faulty.  
E904  
10–104  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
A. GENERAL TIMING CHART ................ A-1  
B. SIGNALS AND ABBREVIATIONS ...... A-2  
C. GENERAL CIRCUIT DIAGRAM.......... A-5  
D. SPECIAL TOOLS LIST........................ A-7  
E. SOLVENTS AND OILS........................ A-8  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. GENERAL TIMING CHART  
A4, 2 Copies, 100%, AE  
Sequence  
Power switch  
ON  
Start key  
ON  
Leading edge  
of 1st page  
Leading edge  
of 2nd page  
Power switch  
OFF  
120°C  
160°C  
WMUP  
WMUPR  
STBY  
STBY  
(flashing)  
Green  
1 Wait indicator  
Target temperature control  
2 Fixing heater (H1)  
3 Main motor (M1)  
Primary charging  
0.6sec  
0.1sec  
0.6sec  
0.4sec  
0.4sec  
4
assembly  
Transfer charging  
assembly  
5
0.1sec  
6 Static eliminator  
7 Developing AC bias  
8 Developing DC bias  
9 Pre-exposure lamp (LA2)  
10 Blank exposure lamp (LA3)  
11 Scanning lamp (LA1)  
12 Scanner motor (M2)  
0.1sec  
Voltage control  
0.6sec  
Partial activation  
0.8sec  
0.4sec  
Forward  
Reverse  
Scanner home position  
13  
sensor (PS1)  
14 Lens motor (M3)  
Lens home position  
15  
sensor (PS2)  
16 Mirror motor (M4)  
Mirror home position  
sensor (PS3)  
17  
0.5sec  
0.5sec  
0.5sec  
18 Pick-up solenoid (SL1)  
Registration paper  
19  
0.5sec  
sensor (PS5)  
Registration roller  
clutch (CL1)  
20  
21 Feed roller clutch (CL2)  
Delivery paper sensor  
(PS6)  
22  
23 Cooling fan 1 (FM1)  
24 Exhaust fan 1 (FM2)  
25 Exhaust fan 2 (FM4)  
Full-speed Half-speed  
rotation rotation  
Cassette / Drum heater  
(H2)  
26  
27 Mirror heater (H3)  
Counter 1 (CNT1)  
28  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B. SIGNALS AND ABBREVIATIONS  
1. Signals  
5V_ON  
5VU ON signal  
MLTPD1  
MLTPD2  
MM_DR  
MM_LKDT  
MMR_A  
MULTIFEEDER PAPER WIDTH DETECTION signal 1  
MULTIFEEDER PAPER WIDTH DETECTION signal 2  
MAIN MOTOR DRIVE command  
AC_24V_ON  
[AE_DATA]  
[AE_REF]  
BLK_CNDR*  
BLK_DEN*  
BLK_LCK  
BLK_PW  
BLK_SCK  
BLK_SD  
AC AND 24V ON signal  
AE SENSOR OUTPUT signal  
AE SENSOR REFERENCE signal  
MAIN MOTOR LOCK DETECTION signal  
MIRROR MOTOR A command  
BLANK EXPOSURE LAMP CENTER DRIVE command  
BLANK EXPOSURE LAMP DRIVE ENABLE signal  
BLANK EXPOSURE LAMP SERIAL DATA LATCH signal  
BLANK EXPOSURE POWER line  
MMR_A*  
MMR_B  
MIRROR MOTOR A* command  
MIRROR MOTOR B command  
MMR_B*  
MMR_COM  
MRRHP  
OPCNT_DR*  
PREXP_DR*  
PU_SL*  
MIRROR MOTOR B* command  
BLANK EXPOSURE LAMP SERIAL DATA CLOCK signal  
BLANK EXPOSURE LAMP SERIAL DATA signal  
CLEANER THERMISTOR signal  
MIRROR MOTOR DRIVE command  
MIRROR HOME POSITION DETECTION signal  
ACCESSORY COUNTER DRIVE command  
PRE-EXPOSURE LAMP DRIVE command  
PICK-UP SOLENOID DRIVE command  
POWER SWITCH signal  
[CLTH]  
[CPY_DNS]  
CSTPDT  
COPY DENSITY VOLUME signal  
CASSETTE PAPER DETECTION signal  
CASSETTE SIZE DETECTION 0 signal  
CASSETTE SIZE DETECTION 1 signal  
CASSETTE SIZE DETECTION 2 signal  
CASSETTE SIZE DETECTION 3 signal  
DEVELOPING AC BIAS CONTROL command  
DEVELOPING AC BIAS DRIVE command  
DEVELOPING DC BIAS CONTROL command  
DEVELOPING DC BIAS DRIVE command  
EXHAUST FAN 0 DRIVE command  
CSTS0  
PW_SW  
RDOPDT  
RG_CL*  
RGPDT  
CSTS1  
RIGHT DOOR OPEN DETECTION signal  
REGISTRATION ROLLER CLUTCH DRIVE command  
REGISTRATION PAPER DETECTION signal  
SCANNER MOTOR A command  
CSTS2  
CSTS3  
DV_AC_CNT  
DV_AC_DR  
DV_DC_CNT  
DV_DC_DR  
EXFAN0_DR  
EXFAN0_DT*  
EXFAN1_DR  
EXFAN1_DT*  
EXITPD  
SC_A  
SC_A*  
SCANNER MOTOR A* command  
SC_B  
SCANNER MOTOR B command  
SC_B*  
SCANNER MOTOR B* command  
SC_COM  
SCFAN_DR  
SCFAN_DT*  
SCHP  
SCANNER MOTOR DRIVE command  
COOLING FAN DRIVE command  
EXHAUST FAN 0 DRIVE DETECTION signal  
EXHAUST FAN 1 DRIVE command  
COOLING FAN DRIVE DETECTION signal  
SCANNER HOME POSITION DETECTION signal  
SORTER KIT FAN DRIVE command  
SORTER KIT FAN DRIVE DETECTION signal  
TOTAL COUNTER DRIVE command  
FIXING MAIN THERMISTOR signal  
FIXING MAIN THERMISTOR DETECTION signal  
FIXING SUB THERMISTOR signal  
EXHAUST FAN 1 DRIVE DETECTION signal  
DELIVERY PAPER DETECTION signal  
FEED ROLLER CLUTCH DRIVE command  
FIXING HEATER DRIVE command  
STFAN_DR  
STFAN_DT*  
TCNT_DR*  
[TH1]  
FEED_CL*  
HEAT_DR  
HEAT_ERR  
HVT_DR  
FIXING HEATER ERROR DETECTION signal  
HVT DRIVE command  
TH1_DT  
[TH2]  
LMP_PWM  
LMPDR  
SCANNING LAMP PULSE WIDTH MODIFICATION signal  
SCANNING LAMP DRIVE command  
SCANNING LAMP DRIVE DETECTION signal  
LENS MOTOR A command  
[TNEMP]  
TNFDT  
TONER EMPTY signal  
LMPDT  
WASTE TONER FULL DETECTION signal  
WASTE TONER FEEDING SCREW LOCKED DETECTION signal  
ZERO CROSS signal  
LNS_A  
TRQMLDT  
ZRCRSS  
LNS_A*  
LENS MOTOR A* command  
LNS_B  
LENS MOTOR B command  
LNS_B*  
LENS MOTOR B* command  
LNS_COM  
LNSHP  
LENS MOTOR DRIVE command  
LENS HOME POSITION DETECTION signal  
MULTIFEED ROLLER CLUTCH DRIVE command  
MULTIFEED SOLENOID DRIVE command  
MULTIFEEDER PAPER DETECTION signal  
MLT_CL*  
MLT_SL*  
MLTPD0  
A–2  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Abbreviations  
AER  
AE ROTATION  
INTR  
INITIAL ROTATION  
LAST ROTATION  
SCANNER FORWARD  
SCANNER REVERSE  
STANDBY  
LSTR  
SCFW  
SCRV  
STBY  
WMUP  
WARM-UP  
WMUPR  
WARM-UP ROTATION  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C. GENERAL CIRCUIT DIAGRAM  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
PRE-  
EXPOSURE  
LAMP  
EXHAUST EXHAUST  
COOLING  
FAN1  
FM1  
P1  
FAN 1  
FM 2  
FAN 2  
FM 4  
SCANNER  
MOTOR  
M2  
1
2
LA2  
3
TO CC-IV N  
M
~
HEATER SWITCH (SW1)  
F
E
D
C
B
A
1
2
2
1
CONTROL PANEL PCB  
2
1
ET1  
3
2
J20  
2
1
3
1
2
J22  
2
1
3
3
1
2
J14  
2
1
3
4
3
2
1
4
3
2
1
2
1
J402  
5
J401  
J403  
CASSETTE/DRUM  
HEATER (H2)  
J790  
J37  
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9
10  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15  
1
2
3
4
5
J501  
1
3
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4
5
TONER  
SENSOR  
1
2
CASSETTE  
HEATER (H4)  
2
1
2
1
TS1  
ET2  
1
3
3
2
J15  
2
3
1
1
1
1
3
2
1
2
1
1
2
MIRROR  
HEATER (H3)  
ACCESSORY  
COUNTER  
CNT2  
TOTAL  
COUNTER  
CNT1  
LA3  
MIRROR  
MOTOR  
M4  
4
4
2
AE  
SENSOR  
SORTER KIT  
FAN  
FM5  
NC  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
1
BLANK EXPOSURE  
LAMP  
LENS  
HOME  
SCANNER  
HOME  
POSITION  
SENSOR  
PS1  
MIRROR  
HOME  
POSITION  
SENSOR  
PS3  
LENS MOTOR  
M3  
J721  
NC  
FIXING HEATER (H1)  
2
3
CNT  
CNT  
POSITION  
SENSOR  
PS2  
RG_CL*  
LMPDR  
NC  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
4
3
2
1
3
3
1
2
N
M
~
1
2
1
2
M
~
4
H
5
THERMO SWIITCH (SW1)  
P
S
P
S
P
S
5
1
4
2
3
J39  
3
2
4
1
5
1
1
2
3
4
4
2
J720  
2
3
1
2
J32  
2
1
3
2
1
2
10  
1
9
2
8
3
7
4
6
5
4
7
3
8
2
9
1
F13  
F15  
F14  
F16  
3
2
J24  
2
1
3
LMPDT  
NC  
6
J11  
2
J10  
2
J12  
2
J531  
J33  
J38  
J551  
7
FT1  
FT2  
LMP_PWM  
TNFDT  
TRQMLDT  
1
3
1
3
1
3
RL1  
TO J307  
8
2
3
1
5
6
10  
1
2
3
4
5
1
3
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
DV_DC_CNT  
DV_DC_DR  
DV_AC_CNT  
DV_AC_DR  
HVT_DR  
MM_LKDT*  
MM_DR  
SCANNING  
LAMP (LA1)  
THERMAL  
FUSE (FU1)  
1
2
3
1
2
3
MT3  
MT4  
2
1
MT2  
J123  
1
1
2
J51  
2
3
3
8
NC  
7
FG  
MT1  
HEAT_ERR  
NC  
6
B12  
A12  
B9  
A9  
B13  
A13  
B15  
A15  
5
POWER SUPPLY  
PCB  
1
2
3
4
5
6
HEAT_DR  
ZRCRSS  
5V_ON  
4
J104  
J103  
J102  
J101  
3
H
2
1
2
3
AC_24V_ON  
1
N
DC CONTROLER PCB  
24V  
1
LAMP  
REGULATOR  
PCB  
1
2
3
4
5
GND  
2
5VU  
5
1
2
3
4
5
5VU  
3
J107  
J122  
LMPDR  
4
3
2
1
7
6
5VR  
4
LMP_PWM  
LMPDT  
GND  
J120  
J121  
GND  
5
J112  
J111  
J110  
J109  
J108  
J124  
B10  
A10  
B15  
A15  
8
8
3
2
1
5
4
3
2
1
2
1
2
1
4
3
2
1
3
2
1
M1  
MM_LKDT*  
MM_DR  
GND  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
CL1  
CL  
M
~
24V  
2
1
2
RG_CL*  
24V  
1
TO RL1  
MAIN  
MOTOR  
REGISTRATION  
2
1
ROLLER CLUTCH  
J23  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
4
2
1
J750  
J752  
1
2
3
1
2
3
1
8
2
7
3
6
4
5
6
3
7
2
8
1
1
7
2
3
4
5
3
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11  
1
3
2
3
1
2
3
J16  
4 5  
J307  
TH1  
TNFDT  
J21  
J40  
J797  
J796  
J700  
FG  
1
2
1
2
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
TH2  
SUB  
MAIN  
THERMISTOR  
THERMISTOR  
TRQMLDT  
5VU  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1
9
2
3
5
4
6
5
4
2
1
11 10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
1
P
S
DV  
CASSETTE SIZE  
SWITCH PCB  
3
PS6  
DELIVERY  
PAPER  
DV_DC_CNT  
DV_DC_DR  
DV_AC_CNT  
DV_AC_DR  
HVT_DR  
GND  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
10 11 12  
5
TH3  
CLEANER  
THERMISTOR  
GRID  
SEALED  
SENSOR  
6
J754  
HIGH-VOLTAGE  
TRANSFORMER  
PCB  
7
TO ADF  
1
2
3
8
9
24V  
SP  
10  
FT7  
J206  
PR  
TR  
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
J303  
J302  
J47  
4
3
2
1
3
2
1
H
N
1
2
1
2
1
2
3
1
2
2
1
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
1
2
1
2
3
J36  
J31  
J30  
TRANSFER GUIDE  
VZ1  
J951  
1
1
2
3
4
4
1
1
2
3
4
4
J48  
J19  
1
2
1
2
J743  
J742  
J18  
J35  
J17  
1
2
ACCESORY POWER  
SUPPLY PCB  
J751  
J753  
FG  
P
S
SL  
SL1  
P
S
SL  
SL2  
MULTI  
FEED  
P
S
P
S
P
S
P
S
CL  
CL  
2
3
1
2
3
2
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
J955  
J952  
PS4  
PS10  
MULTI-  
FEEDER  
PAPER  
WIDHT  
PS9  
PS7  
PS5  
REGISTRATION  
PAPER  
PS11  
RIGHT  
DOOR  
OPEN  
SENSOR  
J722  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
J34  
CL2  
FEED  
ROLLER  
CLUTCH  
CL3  
MULTI  
FEED  
ROLLER  
CLUTCH  
PICK-UP  
SOLENOID  
MULTI-  
FEEDER  
PAPER  
WIDHT  
MULTI-  
FEEDER  
PAPER  
CASSETTE  
PAPER  
WASTE  
TONER  
SENSOR  
B10  
A10  
TO RDD  
P
S
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
SENSOR  
SOLENOID  
SENSOR  
PS8  
SENSOR  
J701  
J755  
TO SORTER  
SENSOR 2 SENSOR 1  
WASTE TONER FEEDING  
SCREW LOCKED SENSOR  
TO CFM  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
D. SPECIAL TOOLS LIST  
No.  
1
Tool description  
Door switch  
Tool No.  
Shape  
Notation  
A
Remarks  
TKN-0093  
Point of use  
Front  
door  
2
Mirror positioning  
tool  
FY9-3009  
B
For adjusting the  
No. 1/No. 2 mirror  
position (front/rear  
as a pair)  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
E. SOLVENTS AND OILS  
No. Description  
Use  
Composition  
C2H5O  
Description  
1
Ethyl alcohol Cleaning:  
• Do not bring near open fire.  
• Procure locally.  
(Etanol)  
e.g., glass,  
plastic,  
rubber parts;  
external covers  
(CHZ3)2 CHOH  
• Isopropyl alcohol may be  
substituted.  
Isopropyl  
alcohol  
(Isopropanol)  
2
3
MEK  
Cleaning:  
e.g., metal;  
oil or toner  
CH3COC2H5  
• Do not bring near fire.  
• Procure locally.  
Heat-resisting Lubricating; e.g., fixing  
Lithium soap  
• CK-0427 (500 g/can)  
grease  
drive assemblies  
(mineral oil family)  
Moblybdenum bisulfide  
4
5
Lubricant oil  
Lubricant oil  
Mineral oil  
(paraffin family)  
• CK-0451 (100 cc)  
• CK-0524 (100 cc)  
Mineral oil  
(paraffin family)  
Lubricating:  
scanner rail  
6
Lubricant oil  
Slicone oil  
• CK-0551 (20 g)  
COPYRIGHT  
©
1998 CANON INC.  
CANON NP7161/NP7160 REV.0 AUG. 1998 PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
A–8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Prepared by  
OFFICE IMAGING PRODUCTS TECHNICAL SUPPORT DEPT. 1  
OFFICE IMAGING PRODUCTS TECHNICAL SUPPORT DIV.  
CANON INC.  
Printed in Japan  
REVISION 0 (AUG. 1998) [23715]  
5-1, Hakusan 7-chome, Toride-shi, Ibaraki 302-8501, Japan  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This publication is printed on  
70% reprocessed paper.  
PRINTED IN JAPAN (IMPRIME AU JAPON)  
0998S0.7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

BenQ Computer Monitor FP71V+ User Manual
BenQ Computer Monitor RL2450H RL2450HT User Manual
BenQ Thermometer sp870 User Manual
Blanco Indoor Furnishings 500 340 User Manual
Bloomfield Coffeemaker 2080 User Manual
Bosch Appliances Security Camera NDN 932 User Manual
Bosch Power Tools Nail Gun FNS138 23 User Manual
Chamberlain Garage Door Opener 1240R 1 4HP User Manual
Chief Manufacturing TV Mount MSP DARKWE CE CD PZ 110 User Manual
Chromalox Electric Heater PF455 3 User Manual